F150A FL150A: Service Manual

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 313

F150A

FL150A

SERVICE MANUAL

290503 63P-28197-3F-11
NOTICE

This manual has been prepared by Yamaha primarily for use by Yamaha dealers and their trained
mechanics when performing maintenance procedures and repairs to Yamaha equipment. It has
been written to suit the needs of persons who have a basic understanding of the mechanical and
electrical concepts and procedures inherent in the work, for without such knowledge attempted
repairs or service to the equipment could render it unsafe or unfit for use.

Because Yamaha has a policy of continuously improving its products, models may differ in detail
from the descriptions and illustrations given in this publication. Use only the latest edition of this
manual. Authorized Yamaha dealers are notified periodically of modifications and significant
changes in specifications and procedures, and these are incorporated in successive editions of this
manual.

Important information 1

Particularly important information is distinguished in this manual by the following notations:

The Safety Alert Symbol means ATTENTION! BECOME ALERT! YOUR SAFETY IS
INVOLVED!

WARNING
Failure to follow WARNING instructions could result in severe injury or death to the machine
operator, a bystander, or a person inspecting or repairing the outboard motor.

CAUTION:
A CAUTION indicates special precautions that must be taken to avoid damage to the out-
board motor.

NOTE:
A NOTE provides key information to make procedures easier or clearer.

F150A, FL150A
SERVICE MANUAL
©2003 by Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
1st Edition, July 2003
All rights reserved.
Any reprinting or unauthorized use
without the written permission of
Yamaha Motor Co., Ltd.
is expressly prohibited.
Printed in the Netherlands
Contents
General information GEN
INFO
1
Specifications
SPEC 2
Periodic checks and adjustments CHK
ADJ
3
Fuel system
FUEL 4
Power unit
POWR 5
Lower unit
LOWR 6
Bracket unit
BRKT 7
– +

Electrical systems
ELEC 8
Troubleshooting TRBL
SHTG
9
Index
GEN
INFO
General information

How to use this manual ................................................................................. 1-1


Manual format............................................................................................ 1-1
Symbols..................................................................................................... 1-2

Safety while working......................................................................................1-3


Fire prevention........................................................................................... 1-3
Ventilation..................................................................................................1-3
Self-protection ........................................................................................... 1-3
Parts, lubricants, and sealants ..................................................................1-3
Good working practices .............................................................................1-4
Disassembly and assembly ....................................................................... 1-4

Identification...................................................................................................1-5
Applicable models .....................................................................................1-5
Serial number ............................................................................................ 1-5

Features and benefits .................................................................................... 1-6


Crankshaft and cylinder.............................................................................1-6
Balancer .................................................................................................... 1-7
Piston and piston ring ................................................................................ 1-7
Connecting rod .......................................................................................... 1-8
Cylinder head cover................................................................................... 1-8
Intake system ............................................................................................ 1-9
Top cowling ............................................................................................. 1-10
64E type power trim and tilt unit ..............................................................1-11
Cooling system ........................................................................................ 1-12
Lubrication system...................................................................................1-13
Fuel system ............................................................................................. 1-15
Rectifier Regulator...................................................................................1-16
Isolator..................................................................................................... 1-16

Technical tips ...............................................................................................1-17


Electronic control system.........................................................................1-17
ECM.........................................................................................................1-17
Fail-safe control ....................................................................................... 1-18
Warning control ....................................................................................... 1-19
Shift cut control........................................................................................ 1-20
Over-revolution control ............................................................................1-20
Fuel pump control....................................................................................1-20

Propeller selection ....................................................................................... 1-21


Propeller size........................................................................................... 1-21
Selection.................................................................................................. 1-21

63P3F11
Predelivery checks ......................................................................................1-22
Checking the fuel system ........................................................................1-22
Checking the gear oil level ...................................................................... 1-22
Checking the engine oil level................................................................... 1-22
Checking the battery................................................................................ 1-22
Checking the outboard motor mounting height........................................ 1-23
Checking the remote control cables ........................................................ 1-23
Checking the steering system .................................................................1-24
1
Checking the gear shift and throttle operation.........................................1-24
Checking the power trim and tilt system.................................................. 1-24
Checking the engine start switch and engine stop lanyard switch ..........1-24
Checking the cooling water pilot hole ......................................................1-25
Test run ................................................................................................... 1-25
2
Break-in ................................................................................................... 1-25
After test run ............................................................................................ 1-25

3
4
5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11
GEN
INFO General information
How to use this manual 1

Manual format
The format of this manual has been designed to make service procedures clear and easy to under-
stand. Use the information below as a guide for effective and quality service.

1 Parts are shown and detailed in an exploded diagram and are listed in the components list.
2 Tightening torque specifications are provided in the exploded diagrams and after a numbered
step with tightening instructions.
3 Symbols are used to indicate important aspects of a procedure, such as the grade of lubricant
and lubrication point.
4 The components list consists of part names and part quantities, as well as bolt and screw dimen-
sions.
5 Service points regarding removal, checking, and installation are shown in individual illustrations
to explain the relevant procedure.

NOTE:
For troubleshooting procedures, see Chapter 9, “Troubleshooting.”

LOWR
Lower unit
3 2 1
Lower unit

LOWR
Lower unit
Removing the drive shaft
1. Remove the drive shaft assembly and
pinion, and then pull out the forward
gear.

S62Y6740K

CAUTION:
Do not reuse the bearing, always replace
S62Y6850K it with a new one.

Drive shaft holder 4 1: 90890-06518


No. Part name Q’ty Remarks Pinion nut holder 2: 90890-06505 Bearing separator 1: 90890-06534
1 Lower unit 1 Socket adapter 2 3: 90890-06507
2 Plastic tie 1 Not reusable
Disassembling the drive shaft 2. Remove the needle bearing from the for-
3 Hose 1 ward gear.
1. Install the pinion nut 1, tighten it finger
4 Check screw 1
tight, and then remove the drive shaft
5 Gasket 2 Not reusable bearing 2 using a press.
6 Dowel pin 2
7 Bolt 4 M10 40 mm
8 Drain screw 1
9 Grommet 1
10 Bolt 1 M10 45 mm
11 Bolt 1 M8 60 mm
12 Thrust washer 1
13 Propeller 1 CAUTION:
14 Washer 1 Do not reuse the bearing, always replace
CAUTION: it with a new one.
15 Washer 1
16 Cotter pin 1 • Do not press the drive shaft threads a
Not reusable
directly. Stopper guide plate 2: 90890-06501
17 Propeller nut 1
• Do not reuse the bearing, always Stopper guide stand 3:
18 Trim tab 1 replace it with a new one. 90890-06538
Bearing puller 4: 90890-06535
Bearing puller claw 1 5:
Bearing inner race attachment 3:
6-5 62Y5A11 90890-06536
90890-06639

Disassembling the forward gear


1. Remove the taper roller bearing from the

4 forward gear using a press.

6-19 62Y5A11

1-1 63P3F11
How to use this manual
Symbols
The symbols below are designed to indicate the content of a chapter.
General information Fuel system Bracket unit
GEN
INFO FUEL BRKT 1
Specifications Power unit Electrical systems

SPEC POWR ELEC – +


2
Periodic checks and adjustments Lower unit Troubleshooting
CHK
ADJ LOWR TRBL
SHTG 3
Symbols 1 to 6 indicate specific data.

1 2 3 4
T.
R.

5 6
4
1
2
3
4
Special tool
Specified oil or fluid
Specified engine speed
Specified tightening torque
5 Specified measurement
6 Specified electrical value
(resistance, voltage, electric current)
5
Symbols 7 to C in an exploded diagram indicate the grade of lubricant and the lubrication point.

7 8 9 0 A B C
6
A M D C I

7
E G

7 Apply Yamaha 4-stroke motor oil A Apply corrosion resistant grease


8 Apply gear oil (Yamaha grease D)
9 Apply water resistant grease (Yamaha grease A) B Apply low temperature resistant grease
0 Apply molybdenum disulfide grease (Yamaha grease C)
C Apply injector grease

Symbols D to I in an exploded diagram indicate the type of sealant or locking agent and the appli-
8
cation point.

D
GM
E
4
F
LT

271
G
LT

242
H
LT

572
I

SS
9
D Apply Gasket Maker G Apply LOCTITE 242 (blue)
E Apply Yamabond No. 4 H Apply LOCTITE 572
F Apply LOCTITE 271 (red) I Apply silicon sealant

63P3F11 1-2
GEN
INFO General information
Safety while working 1

To prevent an accident or injury and to


ensure quality service, follow the safety pro-
cedures provided below.

Fire prevention
Gasoline is highly flammable.
Keep gasoline and all flammable products
away from heat, sparks, and open flames.

Parts, lubricants, and sealants


Use only genuine Yamaha parts, lubricants,
and sealants or those recommended by
Yamaha, when servicing or repairing the out-
board motor.

Ventilation
Gasoline vapor and exhaust gas are heavier
than air and extremely poisonous. If inhaled
in large quantities they may cause loss of
consciousness and death within a short time.
When test running an engine indoors (e.g., in
Under normal conditions, the lubricants men-
a water tank) be sure to do so where ade-
tioned in this manual should not harm or be
quate ventilation can be maintained.
hazardous to your skin. However, you should
follow these precautions to minimize any risk
when working with lubricants.

1. Maintain good standards of personal and


industrial hygiene.

2. Change and wash clothing as soon as


possible if soiled with lubricants.

3. Avoid contact with skin. Do not, for


Self-protection example, place a soiled rag in your
pocket.
Protect your eyes by wearing safety glasses
or safety goggles during all operations involv-
4. Wash hands and any other part of the
ing drilling and grinding, or when using an air
body thoroughly with soap and hot water
compressor.
after contact with a lubricant or lubricant
Protect your hands and feet by wearing pro-
soiled clothing has been made.
tective gloves and safety shoes when neces-
sary. 5. To protect your skin, apply a protective
cream to your hands before working on
the outboard motor.

1-3 63P3F11
Safety while working
6. Keep a supply of clean, lint-free cloths for Disassembly and assembly
wiping up spills, etc. 1. Use compressed air to remove dust and
dirt during disassembly.
Good working practices
Special service tools
Use the recommended special service tools
to protect parts from damage. Use the right
2. Apply engine oil to the contact surfaces
of moving parts before assembly. 1
tool in the right manner—do not improvise.

2
3
3. Install bearings with the manufacture

4
identification mark in the direction indi-
Tightening torques cated in the installation procedure. In
Follow the tightening torque specifications addition, be sure to lubricate the bearings
provided throughout the manual. When tight- liberally.
ening nuts, bolts, and screws, tighten the

5
large sizes first, and tighten fasteners starting 4. Apply a thin coat of water-resistant
in the center and moving outward. grease to the lip and periphery of an oil
Non-reusable parts seal before installation.
Always use new gaskets, seals, O-rings, cot-
ter pins, circlips, etc., when installing or 5. Check that moving parts operate nor-

6
assembling parts. mally after assembly.

7
8
9
63P3F11 1-4
GEN
INFO General information
Identification 1

Applicable models
This manual covers the following models.

Applicable models
F150AET, FL150AET

Serial number
The outboard motor serial number is
stamped on a label attached to the port
clamp bracket.

1 Model name
2 Approved model code
3 Transom height
4 Serial number

Approved Starting
Model name
model code serial No.
L: 1000017–
F150AET 63P
X: 1000044–
L: 1000013–
FL150AET 64P
X: 1000009–

1-5 63P3F11
Identification / Features and benefits
Features and benefits 1

Crankshaft and cylinder


The center of the crankshaft is offset 10 mm (0.39 in) from the center of the cylinder to make more
space to incorporate the throttle body assembly.
This design produces good engine balance and allows a compact design.
Exhaust gas from each cylinder flows directly into the exhaust manifold to obtain a compact design
for the exhaust system.
1
2
2
1 3
3
4
4

5
5 6
1
2
Throttle body assembly
Oil/gas separator
6 S63P1070
7
3 Direct exhaust system
4
5
6
Rectifier Regulator
Offset 10 mm (0.39 in)
Balancer shafts 8
9
63P3F11 1-6
GEN
INFO General information
Balancer
A two-piece balancer is used in the crankcase to reduce the secondary forces of inertia produced by
reciprocating pistons.
The balancer shaft 1 is driven by the gear on the crankshaft.
The balancer shaft 2 is driven by the gear on the balancer shaft 1.
The two counterrotating balancer shafts rotate at twice the speed of the crankshaft and reduce the
forces of inertia of the connecting rods and each balancer shaft.
Therefore, engine vibration is reduced.

S63P1080

1 Balancer shaft 1 3 Piston secondary force of inertia


2 Balancer shaft 2 4 Balancer force of inertia

Piston and piston ring


A forged piston has been adopted for durability.
Hard chromium plating is applied to the piston rings.
The top and 2nd piston rings differ and are identified by a mark on each ring.
Install the piston rings on the piston with the identification marks facing up.

1 2 45˚
45˚
3 2

1 4
R RN
S63P1090

1 Top ring
2 2nd ring
3 Upper oil ring rail
4 Lower oil ring rail

1-7 63P3F11
Features and benefits
Connecting rod
A direction mark for installing the connecting rod to the crankshaft in the proper direction is on the
connecting rod cap.

1
The direction mark should face the flywheel.
The connecting rod and connecting rod cap are manufactured as a single piece. Then, they are split
using impact force. Only use the connecting rods and connecting rod caps in their original combina-
tions, do not interchange them.

1
2
S63P1100 3
1 Direction mark

Cylinder head cover


The oil/gas separator is used to obtain low emissions and is built into the cylinder head cover to
obtain a compact design.
4
The gas and oil flow is shown below.

5
1

6
7

8
2 :É

1 Intake silencer
2 Cylinder head cover (with gas/oil separator)
S63P1110

9
È Blowby gas
É Oil

63P3F11 1-8
GEN
INFO General information
Intake system
Multi-point, group fuel injection with four separate throttle valves is adopted for the intake system.
Intake air volume is calculated according to engine speed, Intake air pressure, and throttle position,
and then the fuel injection volume is determined by the intake air volume to obtain a precise air and
fuel ratio under all operating conditions.
The cylinders are grouped, #1/#4 and #2/#3. Fuel is injected twice during each full cycle of each cyl-
inder, once during the exhaust stroke and once during the compression stroke. Fuel is injected dur-
ing the compression stroke of the #1 cylinder and the exhaust stroke of the #4 cylinder and during
the exhaust stroke of the #1 cylinder and the compression stroke of the #4 cylinder. The same
occurs during the compression and exhaust strokes of the #2 and #3 cylinders.
This allows a simpler fuel injection control system.

Initial injection timing


BTDC10

#1 cylinder Compression Combustion Exhaust Intake

#3 cylinder Intake Compression Combustion Exhaust

#4 cylinder Exhaust Intake Compression Combustion

#2 cylinder Combustion Exhaust Intake Compression

S63P1120

1 Four separate throttle valve

1-9 63P3F11
Features and benefits
The shape of the fuel injectors is the same for the F115, F150, F200 and F225.
Therefore, each fuel injector is identified by color because the specifications of each fuel injector are
different.

È
F115
F150
É
Ë
Ì
Ê
732
731
1
F200
Í

2
741
F225

È Model Ë Orange
S63P1130 3
É Injector color Ì Yellow
Ê First three digits Í Ivory

Top cowling
Water is separated from the intake air and flows down through the drain hoses before draining out
through the bottom cowling.
4
The structure of the top cowling helps to prevent water from accumulating in the top cowling and
entering the power unit.

1
5
2

3
6

7
1 Water separator
2 Air (including water)
S63P1140

8
3 Drain hoses

È Water
9
63P3F11 1-10
GEN
INFO General information
64E type power trim and tilt unit
The 64E type clamp bracket and power trim and tilt unit used for current V4 and V6 outboard motors
have been adopted.
This allows easier interchanging of Yamaha outboards with the same classification because the
mounting dimensions are the same.
For the power trim and tilt unit, only the impact absorber valve opening pressure of the tilt piston
fluid circuit has been changed. The pressure is distinguished from those of other models by an iden-
tification mark stamped on the power trim and tilt unit.

S63P1150

È
Identification mark Applicable models
YA Carbureted V4 and V6 (2.6)
YB N/A
Electronic fuel injected V6 (2.6), HPDI (2.6),
YC
VX200 (200H), VX225 (225G), and VX250 (250C)
YD F115 (F115A), LF115 (FL115A), and (F100B)
YE VZ225 (Z225H) and VZ250 (Z250F)
YF F150 (F150A) and LF150 (FL150A)

1-11 63P3F11
Features and benefits
Cooling system
The cooling water flow diagram is as follows.
To cool the propeller damper, the cooling system is designed so that fresh cooling water is taken in

1
from the front of the trim tab and supplied to the exhaust passage of the lower case to cool the
exhaust gas.
Cooling water also accumulates around the exhaust muffler to cool the upper case and reduce
exhaust noise.

Thermostat
2
Cylinder block

Pressure control valve Cylinder head

Cylinder block
3
Upper case

4
Exhaust cover

Exhaust guide
Lower case
Fuel cooler
Oil pan

Propeller boss
Trim tab
Water pump

Water inlet
Cooling water pilot hole
5
Sea / River / Lake

3
6
4

7
1
8
2

S63P1170
9
1 Exhaust manifold 4 Water
2 Muffler
3 Exhaust gas È Water

63P3F11 1-12
GEN
INFO General information
Lubrication system
The lubrication oil flow diagram is as follows.

Crankcase Cylinder head

Cylinder sleeve
Camshaft
Piston
Balancer
journal Crankpin
IN/EX valve
Camshaft journal
Crankshaft main journal

Main passage

Oil filter
Oil pressure sensor
Oil filter bracket

Relief valve

Oil pump

Oil strainer

Oil pan
S63P1260

There is a small hole in the relief valve to allow oil to drain from the oil filter bracket so that it does
not remain in the oil filter. This prevents oil from spilling out when replacing the oil filter.


1 2
S63P1180

1 Relief valve
2 Oil filter bracket

È Oil

1-13 63P3F11
Features and benefits
A dual oil drain system is adopted.
An oil drain bolt is located on the bottom of the oil pan.
A long dipstick guide, which reaches the bottom of the oil pan, can also be used to pump out the oil

1
completely with an oil-extracting tool.

2
2
3
1

4
S63P1190

1 Drain bolt
2 Dipstick guide

5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11 1-14
GEN
INFO General information
Fuel system
A fuel pressure regulator is incorporated onto the outlet of the electric fuel pump to obtain a compact
design and simple fuel delivery.
Fuel discharged from the pressure regulator returns to the vapor separator after being cooled in the
fuel cooler.
The pressure check valve is incorporated onto the fuel rail for easier servicing of the fuel system.

Fuel filter
Fuel tank Fuel filter (fuel tank) Primer pump Fuel pump
(69J type)

Vapor separator Electric fuel pump Fuel rail Pressure


check valve

Fuel cooler
Fuel Fuel Fuel Fuel
injector injector injector injector
Pressure regulator 1 2 3 4

3
S63P1200

1 Pressure regulator
2 Vapor separator
3 Fuel cooler

È Fuel flow

1-15 63P3F11
Features and benefits
Rectifier Regulator
A water-cooled Rectifier Regulator is incorporated onto the exhaust outer cover.
This allows for a compact engine design and produces a large electric current output for charging

1
the battery under low engine speed.

40

35

2
30

25
È 20

15

10

0 1,000 2,000 3,000 4,000


É
5,000 6,000 7,000

S63P1210
3
È Charging current (A)

4
É Engine speed (r/min)

Isolator
An isolator is incorporated into the Rectifier Regulator. If a second battery is used, connect an
optional isolator lead.

Isolator lead P/N: 69J-81949-00 (3.8 m/12.5 ft)


68F-81949-00 (2.7 m/9 ft) 5
3.8 m (12.5 ft)/2.7 m (9 ft)

6
1 Red tube
1
S63P1220
7
8
9
63P3F11 1-16
GEN
INFO General information
Technical tips 1

Electronic control system


The electronic control system consists of the sensors and the ECM (electronic control module).
Under various conditions, the ECM provides the best suitable engine operation.

2 3 4 5
1

6
7 8
S63P1230

1 Intake air pressure sensor 5 Thermoswitch


2 Engine temperature sensor 6 Intake air temperature sensor
3 Throttle position sensor 7 ECM
4 Pulser coil 8 Oil pressure sensor

ECM
This engine is controlled by the ECM to obtain precise combustion under various operating condi-
tions for high power output, low fuel consumption, and low emissions.
The ECM controls the ignition timing, the fuel injection timing, and the fuel injection volume and
ensures that optimum ignition timing and an optimum air and fuel ratio can be achieved under all
operating conditions such as starting the engine, normal operation, and quick acceleration.
The self-diagnostic function is incorporated into the ECM, and can quickly detect a malfunction
when a personal computer is used with the optional software installed. (Refer to the “Yamaha Diag-
nostic System Instruction Manual”.)

È É
63P-00 EUR
63P-10 USA, CAN, OCE
63P-20 JPN
S63P1240

È ECM identification
É Destination

1-17 63P3F11
Technical tips
Fail-safe control
If the electrical components malfunction, the ECM controls the ignition and fuel injection as shown in
the table.

Malfunctioning item

Pulser coil
Details
No signal received during
four consecutive crankshaft
Ignition control

Fixed to BTDC 10°


Fuel control

Fixed to BTDC 10°


1
rotations

Throttle position
sensor
Output voltage is 0.3 V or
lower or 4.7 V or higher
Controlled accord-
ing to the basic
injection map
Controlled by Intake
air pressure and
engine speed
Fuel injection vol-
2
Intake air pressure Output voltage is 0.2 V or ume is controlled by
sensor

Engine temperature
lower or 4.5 V or higher

Output voltage is 0.18 V or


Normal control

Normal control
the throttle position
sensor

Normal control
3
sensor lower or 4.93 V or higher
Intake air tempera-
ture sensor

Neutral switch
Output voltage is 0.10 V or
lower or 4.61 V or higher
Switch is off when starting
the outboard motor
Normal control

Normal control
Normal control

Normal control
4
The switch is on when the

Thermoswitch
engine temperature is 40 °C
(104 °F) or lower or the
switch is off when the engine
Normal control Normal control
5
temperature is 130 °C

6
(266 °F) or higher.
Output voltage is 4.50 V or
higher, the switch is on when
the outboard motor is
Shift cut switch Normal control Normal control
started, or both the shift cut

Oil pressure sensor


switch and neutral switch are
on for 5 seconds
Output voltage is 0.3 V or
lower or 4.8 V or higher
Normal control Normal control
7
During fail-safe control, the engine idle speed increases to 900 r/min except if the neutral switch is
off when the outboard motor is started.
8
9
63P3F11 1-18
GEN
INFO General information
Warning control
This outboard motor is equipped with warning control functions to avoid serious engine damage.
The engine speed is limited to approximately 2,000 r/min if the engine overheats, if the oil pressure
is low, or if a dual engine system (DES) is operated.
When a switch turns on, the engine speed is controlled as shown in the table.

Engine Engine speed


Thermo- Oil pressure DES
temperature Less than 2,000 r/min
switch sensor signal
sensor 2,000 r/min or more
130 °C Below
Fuel injection Fuel injection is
(266 °F) or specified oil
begins again in the shut off in the
On higher pressure due On
cylinder order #3, cylinder order #1,
(0.63 V or to engine
#4, and #1 #4, and #3.
lower) speed
NOTE:
• The warning indicators light for 3 sec-
Oil pressure onds after the engine start switch is
Overheat warning warning turned on.
Buzzer
indicator lights and indicator lights • The buzzer sounds if the lanyard is
sounds
buzzer sounds and buzzer removed from the engine stop lanyard
sounds switch while starting the outboard
motor.

Fuel injection is shut off in the cylinder order #1, #4, and #3 at 2.5-second intervals when the engine
is running at 2,000 r/min or more.
Fuel injection to the #2 cylinder is not shut off.
When the throttle-opening angle is 30 degrees or less, fuel injection to the #3 cylinder will begin
again.
When the engine speed decreases to less than 2,000 r/min, fuel injection will begin again in the cyl-
inder order #3, #4, and #1 at 0.2-second intervals.
The warning control mode deactivates when the engine speed is less than 1,600 r/min or the throt-
tle-opening angle is less than 7 degrees.

1-19 63P3F11
Technical tips
Shift cut control
This outboard motor is equipped with a shift cut control system for easier shifting.
This device misfires and retards the ignition of some cylinders to fluctuate the engine speed

1
instantly when the engine is running from 400 to 2,000 r/min. This allows smooth engagement
and/or disengagement of the dog clutch.
When shifting, the ignition is shut off as shown in the table.

Engine speed

2
(r/min)
less than 400 400 to 729 730 to 2,000 2,001 or more
Shift cut
switch
Off N/A N/A N/A N/A
Misfires the #1
On N/A
Retards ignition
timing
and #4 cylinders,
and then retards
ignition timing
N/A
3
N/A: No misfire control

Over-revolution control
This outboard motor is equipped with an over-revolution control system to protect the engine.
If the engine speed exceeds 6,200 r/min, the fuel injection is shut off as shown in the table below.
4
5
Engine speed (r/min) Injected cylinder Note
6,199 or less #1, #2, #3, and #4 Normal operation
6,200 to 6,300 #2 and #3
6,301 to 6,550 #2 Over-revolution control mode

6
6,551 or more None

Fuel pump control


The electric fuel pump operates for 3 seconds after the engine start switch is turned on and contin-
ues to operate while the engine is running.
The electric fuel pump stops 1 second after the engine is stopped.

NOTE:
After the engine start switch is turned on, all of the fuel injectors are driven to prevent them from
7
sticking before the electric fuel pump is driven.

8
9
63P3F11 1-20
GEN
INFO General information
Propeller selection 1
Regular rotation model
The performance of a boat and outboard Propeller size (in) Material
motor will be critically affected by the size
13 1/2 × 23 - M
and type of propeller you choose. Propellers
greatly affect boat speed, acceleration, 13 3/4 × 21 - M
engine life, fuel economy, and even boating 14 × 19 - M Aluminum
and steering capabilities. An incorrect choice 14 1/2 × 17 - M
could adversely affect performance and 15 1/4 × 15 - M
could also seriously damage the engine.
13 3/8 × 23 - M
Use the following information as a guide for
selecting a propeller that meets the operating 13 3/8 × 25 - M
conditions of the boat and the outboard 13 3/4 × 17 - M2
motor. 13 3/4 × 19 - M2
13 3/4 × 21 - M
Propeller size
The size of the propeller is indicated on the 14 1/2 × 15 - M
propeller boss end. 14 1/2 × 21 - M
14 1/2 × 23 - M Stainless
14 1/2 × 25 - M
14 1/2 × 27 - M
× -
14 7/8 × 21 - M
a b c
15 × 19 - M
15 1/4 × 15 - M
15 1/4 × 17 - M
S69J1100 15 3/4 × 13 - M
a Propeller diameter (in inches)
b Propeller pitch (in inches)
Counter rotation model
c Propeller type (propeller mark) Propeller size (in) Material

Selection 14 × 19 - ML
Aluminum
When the engine speed is at the full throttle 14 1/2 × 17 - ML
operating range (5,000–6,000 r/min), the 13 3/8 × 23 - ML
ideal propeller for the boat is one that pro- 13 3/4 × 17 - ML1
vides maximum performance in relation to
13 3/4 × 19 - ML1
boat speed and fuel consumption.
13 3/4 × 21 - ML
14 1/2 × 23 - ML Stainless
14 7/8 × 21 - ML
15 1/4 × 15 - ML
15 1/4 × 17 - ML
15 1/4 × 19 - ML

1-21 63P3F11
Propeller selection / Predelivery checks
Predelivery checks 1 Checking the engine oil level
To make the delivery process smooth and 1. Check the engine oil level.
efficient, the predelivery checks should be
completed as explained below.

Checking the fuel system


1. Check that the fuel hoses are securely
1
connected and that the fuel tank is full
with fuel.

2
NOTE:
• If the engine oil is above the maximum level
mark (H), extract sufficient oil with an oil
changer or drain it until the level is between
3
(H) and (L).
• If the engine oil is below the minimum level
mark (L), add sufficient oil until the level is
between (H) and (L). 4
Recommended engine oil:
4-stroke motor oil
API: SE, SF, SG, SH, or SJ
SAE: 10W-30 or 10W-40
Oil capacity:
5
Without oil filter replacement:
CAUTION:
This is a 4-stroke engine. Never use pre-
mixed fuel.
5.2 L (5.5 US qt, 4.6 Imp qt)

Checking the battery


6
1. Check the capacity, electrolyte level, and
Checking the gear oil level
1. Check the gear oil level.
specified gravity of the battery.

Recommended battery capacity:


CCA/EN: 711 A
7
20HR/IEC: 100 Ah
Electrolyte specified gravity:
1.280 at 20 °C (68 °F)

2. Check that the positive and negative bat-


8
tery leads are securely connected.

S60V1290
9
63P3F11 1-22
GEN
INFO General information
Checking the outboard motor
mounting height
1. Check that the anti-cavitation plate is
aligned with the bottom of the boat. If the
mounting height is too high, cavitation
will occur and propulsion will be reduced. 1
Also, the engine speed will increase
abnormally and cause the engine to
overheat. If the mounting height is too 2
S63P1040
low, water resistance will increase and
reduce engine efficiency.
3. Check that the center of the set pin a is
aligned with the alignment mark b on
the bottom cowling.

b
NOTE: a S63P3270
The optimum mounting height is affected by
the combination of the boat and the outboard
motor. To determine the optimum mounting
height, test run the outboard motor at differ-
ent heights.

2. Check that the clamp brackets are


secured with the clamp bolts.
c
Checking the remote control cables S69J3370

1. Set the remote control lever to the neu-


tral position and fully close the throttle CAUTION:
lever. The shift/throttle cable joint must be
screwed in a minimum of 8.0 mm (0.31 in)
2. Check that the stopper 1 on the throttle c.
lever 2 contacts the fully closed stopper
2 on the cylinder block.

1-23 63P3F11
Predelivery checks
Checking the steering system Checking the power trim and tilt
1. Check the steering friction for proper system
adjustment. 1. Check that the outboard motor tilts up

2. Check that
smoothly.
the steering operates
and down smoothly when operating the
power trim and tilt unit.

2. Check that there is no abnormal noise


1
produced when the outboard motor is
tilted up or down.

3. Check that there is no interference with


wires or hoses when the tilted-up out-
2
board motor is steered.

4. Check that the trim meter points down


when the outboard motor is tilted all the
way down.
3
3. Check that there is no interference with

4
wires or hoses when the outboard motor Checking the engine start switch and
is steered. engine stop lanyard switch
1. Check that the engine starts when the
Checking the gear shift and throttle engine start switch is turned to START.
operation
1. Check that the gear shift operates
smoothly when the remote control lever
is shifted from neutral to forward or
reverse.
2. Check that the engine turns off when the
engine start switch is turned to OFF.
5
2. Check that the throttle operates smoothly
when the remote control lever is shifted
from forward or reverse to the fully open
position a.
6
F
N
R

a
S60V1070

3. Check that the engine turns off when the


7
engine stop lanyard is pulled from the

S69J1210
engine stop lanyard switch.

8
9
63P3F11 1-24
GEN
INFO General information
Checking the cooling water pilot
hole
1. Check that cooling water is discharged
from the cooling water pilot hole. a b c

È 0 1 2 10

S69J1240

È Hour

After test run


1. Check for water in the gear oil.

2. Check for fuel leakage in the cowling.


Test run
1. Start the engine, and then check that the 3. Flush the cooling water passage with
gear shift operates smoothly. fresh water using the flushing kit and with
the engine running at idle.
2. Check the engine idle speed after the
engine has been warmed up.

3. Operate at trolling speed.

4. Run the outboard motor for 1 hour at


2,000 r/min or at half throttle, then for
another hour at 3,000 r/min or at 3/4
throttle.

5. Check that the outboard motor does not


tilt up when shifting into reverse and that
water does not flow in over the transom.

NOTE:
The test run is part of the break-in operation.

Break-in
During the test run, perform the break-in
operation in the following three stages.
1. One hour a at 2,000 r/min or at approxi-
mately half throttle

2. One hour b at 3,000 r/min or 3/4 throttle


and 1 minute out of every 10 at full throt-
tle

3. Eight hours c at any speed, however,


avoid running at full speed for more than
5 minutes

1-25 63P3F11
SPEC

Specifications

General specifications................................................................................... 2-1

Maintenance specification ............................................................................2-3


Power unit..................................................................................................2-3
1
Lower unit ..................................................................................................2-6
Electrical .................................................................................................... 2-7
Dimensions................................................................................................2-9

Tightening torques....................................................................................... 2-11


2
Specified torques.....................................................................................2-11

3
General torques....................................................................................... 2-13

4
5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11
SPEC
Specifications
General specifications 2

Model
Item Unit
F150AET FL150AET
Dimension
Overall length mm (in) 822 (32.4)
Overall width mm (in) 511 (20.1)
Overall height
(L) mm (in) 1,714 (67.5)
(X) mm (in) 1,842 (72.5)
Boat transom height
(L) mm (in) 508 (20.0)
(X) mm (in) 635 (25.0)
Weight
(with aluminium propeller)
(L) kg (lb) 214.0 (472)
(X) kg (lb) 218.0 (481)
(with stainless propeller)
(L) kg (lb) 216.0 (476)
(X) kg (lb) 220.0 (485)
Performance
Maximum output kW (hp) 110.3 (150) at 5,500 r/min
Full throttle operating range r/min 5,000–6,000
Maximum fuel consumption L (US gal, 55.8 (14.7, 12.3) at 6,000 r/min
lmp gal)/hr
Engine idle speed r/min 700 ± 50
Power unit
Type 4-stroke L
Cylinder quantity 4
Total displacement cm3 (cu. in) 2,670 (162.9)
Bore × stroke mm (in) 94.0 × 96.2 (3.70 × 3.79)
Compression ratio 9.0
Control system Remote control
Starting system Electric
Fuel system Fuel injection
Ignition system TCI
Maximum generator output V, A 12, 35
Spark plug LFR5A-11 (NGK)
Cooling system Water
Exhaust system Propeller boss
Lubrication system Wet sump

2-1 63P3F11
General specifications

Model
Item Unit
F150AET FL150AET
Fuel and oil
Fuel type
Fuel minimum rating

Engine oil
RON(*1)
PON
Regular unleaded gasoline
91
86
4-stroke motor oil
1
Engine oil grade API SE, SF, SG, SH, or SJ

Engine oil quantity


(without oil filter replacement)
SAE

L (US qt,
10W-30 or 10W-40

5.2 (5.5, 4.6)


2
lmp qt)

3
(with oil filter replacement) L (US qt, 5.4 (5.7, 4.8)
lmp qt)
Gear oil type Hypoid gear oil
Gear oil grade SAE 90
Gear oil quantity cm3 (US oz, 980 (33.1, 34.6) 870 (29.4, 30.7)

Bracket unit
Trim angle
(at 12° boat transom)
lmp oz)

Degree –4.0 to 16.0


4
Tilt-up angle Degree 70.0
Steering angle
Drive unit
Gear shift positions
Degree 35.0 + 35.0

F-N-R
5
Gear ratio 2.00 (28/14)
Reduction gear type
Clutch type
Propeller shaft type
Propeller direction (rear view)
Spiral bevel gear

Clockwise
Dog clutch
Spline
Counterclockwise
6
Propeller mark M ML
Electrical
Battery minimum capacity(*2)
CCA/EN A 711
7
20HR/IEC Ah 100
(*1) RON: Research Octane Number
PON: Pump Octane Number =
(RON + Motor Octane Number)/2
(*2) CCA: Cold Cranking Ampere
8
EN: European Norm (European standard)
IEC: International Electrotechnical Commission

9
63P3F11 2-2
SPEC
Specifications
Maintenance specification 2

Power unit
Model
Item Unit
F150AET FL150AET
Power unit
Minimum compression kPa 880 (8.8, 128)
pressure(*1) (kgf/cm2, psi)
Lubrication oil pressure(*2) kPa 450 (4.5, 65.3) at engine idle speed
(kgf/cm2, psi)
Cylinder head
Warpage limit mm (in) 0.10 (0.0039)

(lines indicate straightedge


position)
Camshaft cap inside diameter mm (in) 25.000–25.021 (0.9843–0.9851)
Cylinders
Bore size mm (in) 94.000–94.017 (3.7008–3.7014)
Taper limit mm (in) 0.08 (0.0032)
Out-of-round limit mm (in) 0.05 (0.0020)
Pistons
Piston diameter (D) mm (in) 93.928–93.934 (3.6979–3.6982)
Measuring point (H) mm (in) 5.0 (0.20)
Piston-to-cylinder clearance mm (in) 0.075–0.080 (0.0030–0.0031)
Piston pin boss bore mm (in) 21.004–21.015 (0.8269–0.8274)
Piston rings
Top ring
Dimension B mm (in) 1.17–1.19 (0.0461–0.0469)
Dimension T mm (in) 2.80–3.00 (0.1102–0.1181)
End gap mm (in) 0.15–0.30 (0.0059–0.0118)
Side clearance mm (in) 0.04–0.08 (0.0016–0.0031)
2nd piston ring
Dimension B mm (in) 1.17–1.19 (0.0461–0.0469)
Dimension T mm (in) 3.70–3.90 (0.1457–0.1535)
End gap mm (in) 0.30–0.45 (0.0118–0.0177)
Side clearance mm (in) 0.03–0.07 (0.0012–0.0028)
(*1) Measure conditions:
Ambient temperature 20 °C (68 °F), wide open throttle, with spark plugs removed from all cylinders.
The figures are for reference only.
(*2) The figures are for reference only.

2-3 63P3F11
Maintenance specification

Model
Item Unit
F150AET FL150AET
Oil ring
Dimension B
Dimension T
End gap
Side clearance
mm (in)
mm (in)
mm (in)
mm (in)
2.40–2.47 (0.0945–0.0972)
2.30–2.70 (0.0906–0.1063)
0.15–0.60 (0.0059–0.0236)
0.04–0.13 (0.0016–0.0051)
1
Camshafts
Intake (A)
Exhaust (A)
Intake and
mm (in)
mm (in)
mm (in)
45.300–45.400 (1.7835–1.7874)
44.350–44.450 (1.7461–1.7500)
35.950–36.050 (1.4154–1.4193)
2
exhaust (B)
Camshaft journal diameter
Camshaft journal oil clearance
Camshaft runout limit
Valves
mm (in)
mm (in)
mm (in)
24.960–24.980 (0.9827–0.9835)
0.020–0.060 (0.0008–0.0024)
0.03 (0.0012)
3
Valve clearance (cold)
Intake
Exhaust
Head diameter (A)
mm (in)
mm (in)
0.20 ± 0.03 (0.008 ± 0.001)
0.34 ± 0.03 (0.013 ± 0.001) 4
Intake mm (in) 34.85–35.15 (1.37–1.38)
Exhaust
Face width (B)
Intake
Exhaust
mm (in)

mm (in)
mm (in)
29.85–30.15 (1.18–1.19)

2.11 (0.0831)
2.43 (0.0957)
5
Seat contact width (C)
Intake
Exhaust
Margin thickness (D)
mm (in)
mm (in)
1.10–1.40 (0.0433–0.0551)
1.40–1.70 (0.0551–0.0669) 6
Intake mm (in) 0.70 (0.0276)

7
Exhaust mm (in) 1.00 (0.0394)
Stem diameter
Intake mm (in) 5.477–5.492 (0.2156–0.2162)
Exhaust mm (in) 5.464–5.479 (0.2151–0.2157)
Guide inside diameter
Intake and exhaust
Stem-to-guide clearance
Intake and exhaust
mm (in)

mm (in)
5.504–5.522 (0.2167–0.2174)

0.025–0.058 (0.0010–0.0023)
8
Stem runout limit mm (in) 0.01 (0.0004)

9
Valve springs
Free length mm (in) 44.20 (1.7402)
Minimum free length mm (in) 42.60 (1.6771)
Tilt limit mm (in) 1.5 (0.06)

63P3F11 2-4
SPEC
Specifications

Model
Item Unit
F150AET FL150AET
Valve lifters
Valve lifter outside diameter mm (in) 32.982–32.997 (1.2985–1.2990)
Valve lifter-to-cylinder head mm (in) 0.020–0.055 (0.0008–0.0022)
clearance
Valve shims
Valve shim thickness mm (in) 2.3–2.9 (0.09–0.12)
(in 0.020 mm increments)
Connecting rods
Big-end inside diameter mm (in) 53.025–53.045 (2.0876–2.0884)
Crankpin oil clearance mm (in) 0.027–0.052 (0.0011–0.0020)
Big-end bearing thickness
Green mm (in) 1.496–1.502 (0.0589–0.0591)
Blue mm (in) 1.505–1.511 (0.0593–0.0595)
Red mm (in) 1.514–1.520 (0.0596–0.0598)
Crankshaft
Crankshaft journal diameter mm (in) 51.980–52.000 (2.0465–2.0472)
Crankpin diameter mm (in) 49.980–50.000 (1.9677–1.9685)
Crankpin width mm (in) 22.00–22.10 (0.8661–0.8701)
Runout limit mm (in) 0.03 (0.0012)
Crankcase
Crankshaft main journal oil mm (in) 0.021–0.050 (0.0008–0.0020)
clearance
Upper crankcase main journal
bearing thickness
Green mm (in) 2.506–2.509 (0.0987–0.0988)
Red mm (in) 2.512–2.515 (0.0989–0.0990)
Yellow mm (in) 2.518–2.521 (0.0991–0.0993)
Lower crankcase main journal
bearing thickness
Green mm (in) 2.506–2.509 (0.0987–0.0988)
Red mm (in) 2.512–2.515 (0.0989–0.0990)
Yellow mm (in) 2.518–2.521 (0.0991–0.0993)
Blue + green mm (in) 2.524–2.527 (0.0994–0.0995)
Main journal bearing #3
thickness (lower)
Green mm (in) 2.504–2.509 (0.0986–0.0988)
Red mm (in) 2.510–2.515 (0.0988–0.0990)
Yellow mm (in) 2.516–2.521 (0.0991–0.0993)

2-5 63P3F11
Maintenance specification

Model
Item Unit
F150AET FL150AET
Oil pump
Discharge
at 97–103 °C (207–217 °F)
with 10W-30 engine oil
Pressure
L (US gal,
lmp gal)/min

kPa
8.0 (2.113, 1.760) at 700 r/min

132.0–162.0 (1.32–1.62, 19.1–23.5)


1
(kgf/cm2, psi)
Relief valve opening pressure

Thermostats
kPa
(kgf/cm2, psi)
392–490 (3.92–4.90, 56.84–71.05)
2
Opening temperature °C (°F) 58–62 (136–144)

3
Fully open temperature °C (°F) 70 (158)
Valve open lower limit mm (in) 4.3 (0.17)

Lower unit
Model

4
Item Unit
F150AET FL150AET
Gear backlash
Pinion-to-forward gear mm (in) 0.14–0.46 0.14–0.42
(0.0055–0.0181) (0.0055–0.0165)

5
Pinion-to-reverse gear mm (in) 0.32–0.67 0.23–0.58
(0.0126–0.0264) (0.0090–0.0228)
Pinion shims mm 0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, 0.50
Forward gear shims mm 0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, 0.50
Reverse gear shims mm 0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, 0.50
Propeller shaft shims

Propeller shaft
End play
mm

mm (in) —
— 0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18,
0.30, 0.40, 0.50

0.25–0.35
6
(0.0098–0.0138)

7
8
9
63P3F11 2-6
SPEC
Specifications
Electrical
Model
Item Unit
F150AET FL150AET
Ignition and ignition control
system
Ignition timing (cylinder #1) Degree TDC at engine idle speed
Spark plug gap mm (in) 1.0–1.1 (0.039–0.043)
Ignition coil resistance
Primary coil (R – B/W)
at 20 °C (68 °F) Ω 1.53–2.07
Secondary coil
at 20 °C (68 °F) kΩ 12.50–16.91
ECM output peak voltage
(B/O, B/W – B)
at cranking (loaded) V 260
at 1,500 r/min (loaded) V 260
at 3,500 r/min (loaded) V 270
Pulser coil output peak voltage
(W/R, W/B – B)
at cranking (unloaded) V 3.5
at cranking (loaded) V 3.6
at 1,500 r/min (loaded) V 23.9
at 3,500 r/min (loaded) V 49.7
Pulser coil resistance(*1) Ω 459–561
(W/R, W/B – B)
Pulser coil air gap mm (in) 0.3–0.7 (0.0118–0.0276)
Throttle position sensor
Input voltage (O – B) V 5
Output voltage (P – B) V 0.70 ± 0.02 at engine idle speed
Intake air temperature sensor
resistance
at 20 °C (68 °F) kΩ 2.20–2.70
Engine temperature sensor
resistance (B/Y – B/Y)
at 20 °C (68 °F) kΩ 54.2–69.0
at 100 °C (212 °F) kΩ 3.12–3.48
Fuel control system
Fuel injector resistance(*1)
at 20 °C (68 °F) Ω 14.0–15.0
(*1)
The figures are for reference only.

2-7 63P3F11
Maintenance specification

Model
Item Unit
F150AET FL150AET
Starter motor
Type
Output
Cranking time limit
Brushes
kW
Second
Sliding gear
1.40
30
1
Standard length mm (in) 15.5 (0.61)
Wear limit
Commutator
Standard diameter
mm (in)

mm (in)
9.5 (0.37)

29.0 (1.14)
2
Wear limit mm (in) 28.0 (1.10)
Mica
Standard undercut
Wear limit
Charging system
mm (in)
mm (in)
0.5–0.8 (0.02–0.03)
0.2 (0.01)
3
Fuse A 20, 30, 50
Stator coil output peak voltage

at cranking (unloaded)
(G – G)
V 12
4
at 1,500 r/min (unloaded) V 50
at 3,500 r/min (unloaded)
Stator coil resistance(*1)
at 20 °C (68 °F) (G – G)
Rectifier Regulator output
V


110

0.20–0.30
5
peak voltage (R – B)
at 1,500 r/min (unloaded)
at 3,500 r/min (unloaded)
Power trim and tilt system
V
V
13.0
13.0 6
Trim sensor

7
Setting resistance (P – B) 9–11
Resistance (P – B) Ω 9–378.8
Fluid type ATF Dexron II
Brushes
Standard length mm (in) 9.8 (0.39)
Wear limit
Commutator
Standard limit
mm (in)

mm (in)
4.8 (0.19)

22.0 (0.87)
8
Wear limit mm (in) 21.0 (0.83)

9
Mica
Standard undercut mm (in) 1.3 (0.05)
Wear limit mm (in) 0.8 (0.03)
(*1)
The figures are for reference only.

63P3F11 2-8
SPEC
Specifications
Dimensions
Exterior

mm (in)

660 (26.0)
256 (10.1) 433 (17.0)

35˚
L: 1,032 (40.7)
629 (24.8) X: 1,148 (45.2)

164 (6.5) 698 (27.5)

75 (3.0)
915 (36.0)

769 (30.1)

455 (17.9)

45 (1.8)

16 (0.6)
X: 643 (25.3)
210 (8.3) L: 516 (20.3)

162(6.4)
X: 1,073 (42.2)
L: 946 (37.2)

X: 864 (34.0)
L: 787 (31.0)

L: 60
X: 80 (2.4)
˚
66

(3.1)

1 2˚
27(1.1)

L: 35 (1.4) 4˚
X: 43 (1.7) 646 (25.4)

S63P2010

2-9 63P3F11
Maintenance specification
Clamp bracket

mm (in)

1
2
180 (7.1) 180 (7.1)

163.5 (6.4) 163.5 (6.4) 3


50.8 (2.0)

4
82 (3.2)

5
254 (10.0)

13 (0.5)
18.5 (0.7)
367 (14.4)

6
55.5 (2.2)

125.4 (4.9) 125.4 (4.9)


13 (0.5)
7
8
S63P2020
9
63P3F11 2-10
SPEC
Specifications
Tightening torques 2

Specified torques
Tightening torques
Part to be tightened Thread size
N·m kgf·m ft·lb
Fuel system
Fuel filter holder bolt M6 8 0.8 5.9
Fuel filter bracket bolt M6 8 0.8 5.9
Fuel pump mounting bolt M6 10 1.0 7.4
Fuel pump screw ø6 4 0.4 3.0
Fuel cooler bolt M6 5 0.5 3.7
Vapor separator mounting bolt M6 5 0.5 3.7
Fuel rail mounting bolt M8 13 1.3 9.6
Throttle body mounting bolt M8 13 1.3 9.6
Power unit
M8 20 2.0 14.8
Power unit mounting bolt
M10 42 4.2 31.0
Apron bolt M6 8 0.8 5.9
Apron screw ø6 4 0.4 3.0
Flywheel magnet nut (M24) 270 27.0 199.1
Starter motor bolt M8 29 2.9 21.4
Starter motor terminal nut (M8) 9 0.9 6.6
Starter relay lead bolt M6 4 0.4 3.0
Ignition coil bolt M6 7 0.7 5.2
Oil filter — 18 1.8 13.3
PTT relay nut (M6) 4 0.4 3.0
PTT motor lead bolt M6 4 0.4 3.0
Positive battery cable nut (M8) 9 0.9 6.6
Timing belt tensioner bolt — 39 3.9 28.8
Drive sprocket bolt M5 7 0.7 5.2
Driven sprocket bolt M10 60 6.0 44.3
1st 8 0.8 5.9
Camshaft cap bolt M7
2nd 17 1.7 12.5
Cylinder head cover plate screw ø4 2 0.2 1.5
1st 8 0.8 5.9
Cylinder head cover bolt M6
2nd 8 0.8 5.9
1st 14 1.4 10.3
M8
2nd 28 2.8 20.7
Cylinder head bolt 1st 19 1.9 14.0
2nd M10 37 3.7 27.3
3rd 90°
Spark plug — 25 2.5 18.4
Engine temperature sensor — 15 1.5 11.1
Cylinder block plug M14 23 2.3 17.0
Engine hanger bolt M6 12 1.2 8.9
Oil pressure sensor — 18 1.8 13.3

2-11 63P3F11
Tightening torques

Tightening torques
Part to be tightened Thread size
N·m kgf·m ft·lb
1st 6 0.6 4.4
Exhaust cover bolt M6

Thermostat cover bolt


2nd
1st
2nd
M6

M14
12
6
12
23
1.2
0.6
1.2
2.3
8.9
4.4
8.9
17.0
1
Exhaust cover plug
M18 55 5.5 40.6
Oil filter union bolt

Balancer bolt
1st
2nd

M6
34
7
13
3.4
0.7
1.3
25.1
5.2
9.6
2
1st 18 1.8 13.3
M8

Oil pump screw


2nd

1st
2nd

M8
31
4
14
26
3.1
0.4
1.4
2.6
22.9
3.0
10.3
19.2
3
Crankcase bolt
1st 30 3.0 22.1

Main bearing cap bolt


2nd
1st
2nd
M10

M10
30
90°
3.0
90°
22.1 4
1st 23 2.3 17.0
Connecting rod cap

Lower unit (regular rotation model)


Gear oil drain screw
2nd
3rd


43

9
4.3
90°

0.9
31.7

6.6
5
Gear oil check screw — 9 0.9 6.6
Lower case mounting bolt
Trim tab bolt
Propeller nut
M10
M10
(M18)
47
42
52
4.7
4.2
5.2
34.7
31.0
38.4
6
Ring nut — 142 14.2 104.7
Cooling water inlet cover screw
Pinion nut
Lower unit (counter rotation model)
Gear oil drain screw

(M16)


4
93

9
0.4
9.3

0.9
3.0
68.6

6.6
7
Gear oil check screw — 9 0.9 6.6
Lower case mounting bolt
Trim tab bolt
Propeller nut
M10
M10
(M18)
47
42
52
4.7
4.2
5.2
34.7
31.0
38.4
8
Ring nut — 142 14.2 104.7

9
Cooling water inlet cover screw — 4 0.4 3.0
Pinion nut (M16) 93 9.3 68.6
Bracket unit
Shift rod detent bolt — 18 1.8 13.3
Flushing hose adapter screw ø6 3 0.3 2.2
Upper mount bracket bolt M10 54 5.4 39.8

63P3F11 2-12
SPEC
Specifications

Tightening torques
Part to be tightened Thread size
N·m kgf·m ft·lb
M8 20 2.0 14.8
Muffler assembly bolt
M10 42 4.2 31.0
Engine oil drain bolt M14 27 2.7 20.0
Baffle plate screw ø5 4 0.4 3.0
Muffler bolt M8 20 2.0 14.8
Exhaust manifold bolt M8 20 2.0 14.8
Oil pan bolt M8 20 2.0 14.8
Oil strainer bolt M6 10 1.0 7.4
Upper mounting nut (M14) 74 7.4 54.6
Lower mounting nut (M14) 74 7.4 54.6
Trim stopper nut (M10) 48 4.8 35.4
Self-locking nut — 15 1.5 11.1
Trim sensor cam screw ø6 2 0.2 1.5
Grease nipple — 3 0.3 2.2
Power trim and tilt unit
Reservoir cap — 0.7 0.07 0.5
Reservoir mounting bolt M6 5 0.5 3.7
PTT motor mounting bolt M6 5 0.5 3.7
Gear pump cover bolt — 6 0.6 4.4
Gear pump housing mounting bolt — 8 0.8 5.9
Manual valve — 3 0.3 2.2
Trim cylinder end screw — 78 7.8 57.5
Tilt cylinder end screw — 130 13.0 96.0
Tilt piston nut — 96 9.6 70.8

General torques
General torque
This chart specifies tightening torques for
Nut (A) Bolt (B) specifications
standard fasteners with a standard ISO
thread pitch. Tightening torque specifications N·m kgf·m ft·lb
for special components or assemblies are 8 mm M5 5 0.5 3.6
provided in applicable sections of this man- 10 mm M6 8 0.8 5.8
ual. To avoid warpage, tighten multi-fastener 12 mm M8 18 1.8 13
assemblies in a crisscross fashion and pro- 14 mm M10 36 3.6 25
gressive stages until the specified torque is 17 mm M12 43 4.3 31
reached. Unless otherwise specified, torque
specifications require clean, dry threads.
Components should be at room temperature.

2-13 63P3F11
CHK
ADJ
Periodic checks and adjustments

Special service tools .....................................................................................3-1

Maintenance interval chart............................................................................3-2 1


Top cowling .................................................................................................... 3-3
Checking the top cowling...........................................................................3-3

Fuel system .................................................................................................... 3-3


Checking the fuel joint and fuel hoses (fuel joint-to-fuel injector) ..............3-3
2
Checking the fuel filter ............................................................................... 3-3

Power unit....................................................................................................... 3-4


Checking the engine oil .............................................................................3-4
Changing the engine oil using an oil changer............................................3-4
3
Changing the engine oil by draining it .......................................................3-5
Replacing the oil filter ................................................................................ 3-5
Checking the timing belt ............................................................................3-6
Replacing the timing belt ...........................................................................3-6
Checking the valve clearance.................................................................... 3-6
4
Checking the spark plugs ..........................................................................3-6
Checking the thermostat............................................................................3-7
Checking the cooling water passage.........................................................3-8

Control system ............................................................................................... 3-8


5
Checking the engine idle speed ................................................................3-8
Adjusting the throttle link and throttle cable............................................... 3-8
Adjusting the throttle link and throttle cable operation
(using a thickness gauge)...................................................................... 3-10
Checking the gear shift operation............................................................ 3-11
6
Checking the ignition timing..................................................................... 3-12

Power trim and tilt unit ................................................................................ 3-13


Checking the power trim and tilt operation .............................................. 3-13
Checking the power trim and tilt fluid level .............................................. 3-13
7
Lower unit ..................................................................................................... 3-13
Checking the gear oil level ...................................................................... 3-13
Changing the gear oil .............................................................................. 3-14
Checking the lower unit for air leakage ...................................................3-15
8
Checking the propeller............................................................................. 3-15

General..........................................................................................................3-15
Checking the anodes............................................................................... 3-15
Checking the battery................................................................................ 3-16
9
Lubricating the outboard motor................................................................3-16

63P3F11
CHK
ADJ Periodic checks and adjustments
Special service tools 3

Oil filter wrench


90890-06830

Digital tachometer
90890-06760

Timing light
90890-03141

Leakage tester
90890-06840

3-1 63P3F11
Special service tools / Maintenance interval chart
Maintenance interval chart 3

Use the following chart as a guideline for general maintenance.


Adjust the maintenance intervals according to the operating conditions of the outboard motor.

Item

Anodes (external)
Remarks

Check/replace
Initial Every
10 hours 50 hours 100 hours 200 hours
(1 month) (3 months) (6 months) (1 year)
Refer to
page
3-15
1
Battery Check/charge 3-16
Cooling water passages
Top cowling
Fuel filter
Clean
Check
Check/replace
3-8
3-3
3-3
2
(can be disassembled)

3
Fuel system Check 3-3
Gear oil Change 3-14
Lubrication points Lubricate 3-16
Engine idle speed Check/adjust 3-8
(EFI models)
PCV (Pressure Control Valve)
Power trim and tilt unit
Propeller and cotter pin
Shift link/shift cable
Check
Check
Check/replace
Check/adjust
5-37
3-13
3-15
3-11
4
Thermostat Check 3-7
Throttle link/throttle cable/
throttle pick-up timing
Water pump
Check/adjust

Check
3-8, 3-10

6-9, 6-37
5
Engine oil Check/change 3-4
Oil filter
Spark plugs

Timing belt
Change
Clean/adjust/
replace
Check/replace
3-5
3-6

3-6, 5-16
6
NOTE:
When operating in salt water, turbid or muddy water, the engine should be flushed with clean water
after each use.
7
Timing belt
Item Remarks

Replace
500 hours
(2.5 years)
Every
1,000 hours
(5 years)
2,000 hours
(10 years)
Refer to
page
5-16
8
Valve clearance (DOHC) Check/adjust 5-12
Anodes (internal)
Balancer
Check/replace
Replace

— 9
NOTE:
When using lead or high-sulfur gasoline, checking valve clearance may be required more frequently
than every 500 hours.

63P3F11 3-2
CHK
ADJ Periodic checks and adjustments
Top cowling 3

Checking the top cowling


1. Check the fitting by pushing the cowling
with both hands. Adjust if necessary.

S63P3030

Fuel system 3

Checking the fuel joint and fuel


hoses (fuel joint-to-fuel injector)
1. Remove the spark plug wire cover.
2. Loosen the bolts 1.
2. Check the low-pressure fuel hose con-
3. Move the hook 2 up or down slightly to nections and fuel joints for leaks.
adjust its position. Replace if necessary. Also, check the
fuel filter 1, fuel pumps 2, and fuel filter
3 for leaks or deterioration. Replace if
necessary.

3. Check the high-pressure fuel hose con-


nections for leaks. Replace if necessary.
Also, check the vapor separator 4, fuel
rail 5, fuel injectors 6, pressure regula-
tor 7, and fuel cooler 8 for leaks or
deterioration. Replace if necessary.
NOTE:
• To loosen the fitting, move the hook in
direction a.
• To tighten the fitting, move the hook in
direction b.

4. Tighten the bolts.

5. Check the fitting again and, if necessary,


repeat steps 2–4.

6. Check the top cowling hose for cracks or


damage. Replace if necessary.

Checking the fuel filter


1. Check the fuel filter element 1 for dirt
and residue and check the fuel filter cup
2 for foreign substances and cracks.
Clean the cup with straight gasoline and
replace the element if necessary.

3-3 63P3F11
Top cowling / Fuel system / Power unit
Changing the engine oil using an oil
changer
1. Start the engine, warm it up, and then
turn it off.

2. Remove the engine oil dipstick and oil


filler cap 1.
1
NOTE:
Be sure not to spill any fuel when removing
2
the fuel filter cup.

Power unit
Checking the engine oil
3
3
1. Place the outboard motor in an upright 3. Insert the tube of the oil changer 2 into
position.

2. Remove the engine oil dipstick, wipe it


clean, and then insert it back into the oil
the dipstick guide 3.
4
filler hole.

3. Remove the dipstick again to check the


oil level and to check the oil for discolora-
tion and its viscosity.
3
5
2
6
S63P3070

4. Operate the oil changer to extract the oil. 7


NOTE:
Be sure to clean up any oil spills.
NOTE:
• Change the oil if it appears milky or dirty.
• If the engine oil is above the maximum level
mark (H), extract sufficient oil using an oil
5. Pour the specified amount of the recom-
mended engine oil into the oil filler hole.
8
changer or drain it until the level is between
(H) and (L).
• If the engine oil is below the minimum level
mark (L), add sufficient oil until the level is
between (H) and (L).
Recommended engine oil:
4-stroke motor oil
API: SE, SF, SG, SH, or SJ
SAE: 10W-30 or 10W-40
9
Oil quantity:
Without oil filter replacement:
5.2 L (5.5 US qt, 4.6 Imp qt)

63P3F11 3-4
CHK
ADJ Periodic checks and adjustments
6. Install the oil filler cap and dipstick, and
then start the engine and warm it up for 5 Recommended engine oil:
minutes. 4-stroke motor oil
API: SE, SF, SG, SH, or SJ
7. Turn the engine off, and then check the SAE: 10W-30 or 10W-40
oil level and correct it if necessary. Oil quantity:
Without oil filter replacement:
Changing the engine oil by draining 5.2 L (5.5 US qt, 4.6 Imp qt)
it
1. Start the engine, warm it up, and then 6. Install the oil filler cap and dipstick, and
turn it off. then start the engine and warm it up for 5
minutes.
2. Remove the engine oil dipstick and oil
filler cap 1. 7. Turn the engine off, and then check the
oil level and correct it if necessary.

Replacing the oil filter


1. Extract the engine oil with an oil changer
or drain it.

2. Place a rag under the oil filter, and then


remove the oil filter using a 72.5 mm (2.9
in) oil filter wrench.

3. Place a drain pan under the drain hole,


and then remove the drain bolt 2 and let
the oil drain completely.

1
S63P3090

NOTE:
• Wait more than 5 minutes after turning the
engine off to replace the oil filter.
• Be sure to clean up any oil spills.

NOTE:
Be sure to clean up any oil spills.
Oil filter wrench 1: 90890-06830

4. Install the drain bolt, and then tighten it to


3. Apply a thin coat of engine oil to the O-
the specified torque.
ring of the new oil filter.
Drain bolt:
4. Install the oil filter, and then tighten it to
27 N·m (2.7 kgf·m, 20.0 ft·lb)
T.
R.

the specified torque using a 72.5 mm


(2.9 in) oil filter wrench.
5. Pour the specified amount of the recom-
mended engine oil into the oil filler hole.

3-5 63P3F11
Power unit

E
1
b

Replacing the timing belt


S63P3040

2
NOTE:

3
S63P3100
For replacement procedures, see Chapter 5,
Oil filter: “Replacing the timing belt.”
18 N·m (1.8 kgf·m, 13.3 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Checking the valve clearance


5. Pour the specified amount of the recom-
mended engine oil into the oil filler hole.

Recommended engine oil:


NOTE:
For checking procedures, see Chapter 5,
“Checking the valve clearance.”
4
4-stroke motor oil
API: SE, SF, SG, SH, or SJ
SAE: 10W-30 or 10W-40
Oil quantity:
With oil filter replacement:
Checking the spark plugs
1. Disconnect the spark plug wires, and
then remove the spark plugs.
5
5.4 L (5.7 US qt, 4.8 Imp qt)
2. Clean the electrodes 1 with a spark plug
6. Install the oil filler cap and dipstick, and
then start the engine and warm it up for 5
minutes.
cleaner or wire brush. Replace the spark
plug if necessary. 6
7. Turn the engine off, and then check the
oil level and correct it if necessary.

Checking the timing belt


7
1. Remove the flywheel magnet cover.

2. While turning the flywheel magnet clock-


wise, check the interior a and the exte-
rior b of the timing belt for cracks,
8
3. Check the electrodes for erosion and
damage, or wear. Replace if necessary.

9
excessive carbon or other deposits, and
3. Turn the crankshaft clockwise two turns the gasket for damage. Replace the
to take up slack in the timing belt. spark plug if necessary.

63P3F11 3-6
CHK
ADJ Periodic checks and adjustments
4. Check the spark plug gap a. Adjust if out 3. Suspend the thermostat in a container of
of specification. water.

4. Place a thermometer in the water and


slowly heat the water.

Specified spark plug:


LFR5A-11 (NGK) S69J5E40

Spark plug gap a:


1.0–1.1 mm (0.039–0.043 in) 5. Check the thermostat valve opening at
the specified water temperatures.
5. Install the spark plugs, tighten them fin- Replace if out of specification.
ger tight b, then to the specified torque
using a spark plug wrench c.

Water
Valve lift a
temperature
Spark plug: 0.05 mm
58–62 °C
25 N·m (2.5 kgf·m, 18.4 ft·lb)
T.

(0.0020 in)
R.

(136–144 °F)
(valve begins to lift)
Checking the thermostat above more than
1. Remove the flywheel magnet cover. 70 °C (158 °F) 4.3 mm (0.17 in)

2. Remove the cover 1 and thermostat 2. 6. Install the thermostat and cover, and
then tighten the cover bolts to the speci-
2 fied torques in two stages.
1
Thermostat cover bolt:
1st: 6 N·m (0.6 kgf·m, 4.4 ft·lb)
T.
R.

2nd: 12 N·m (1.2 kgf·m, 8.9 ft·lb)

S63P3110

3-7 63P3F11
Power unit / Control system
Checking the cooling water passage
1. Check the cooling water inlet cover 1
and cooling water inlet for clogs. Clean if

1
necessary. 1

S63P3140

Digital tachometer: 90890-06760


2
1

1
Engine idle speed: 700 ± 50 r/min 3
Adjusting the throttle link and

S60V3130
throttle cable
NOTE:
• Be sure to synchronize the throttle valves
4
before adjusting the throttle cable.
2. Place the lower unit in water, and then
start the engine.

3. Check for water flow at the cooling water


• For synchronizing procedures, see Chapter
4, “Synchronizing the throttle valves.”

1. Remove the intake silencer.


5
pilot hole. If there is no water flow, check
the cooling water passage inside the out-
board motor.
2. Loosen the locknut 1, remove the clip
2, and then disconnect the throttle cable
joint 3.
6
3. Loosen the locknut 4, and then discon-
nect the throttle link rod joint 5 and the
link rod joint 6.
7
Control system 3
45

6
8
Checking the engine idle speed
1. Start the engine and warm it up for 5 min-
utes.

2. Attach the special service tool to spark


2 1
9
plug wire #1 1, and then check the
engine idle speed. 3 S63P3150

63P3F11 3-8
CHK
ADJ Periodic checks and adjustments
4. Turn throttle lever 1 7 and the throttle
cam 8 counterclockwise so that they are a
in the positions shown in the illustration.

S63P3160 0
A S63P3180
5. Check that the throttle valves are fully
closed, and then adjust the throttle link NOTE:
rod joint to align its hole with the ball joint If there is no clearance, loosen the locknut 4
9 on throttle lever 1. and the throttle link rod joint one turn, and
then repeat steps 6 and 8.

9
9. Operate throttle lever 2 to check that the
throttle valves fully close and fully open.

b
S63P3170
B
6. Connect the throttle link rod joint 5, and
then tighten the locknut 4.

7. Connect the link rod joint 6. S63P3190

NOTE:
8. Contact the stopper 0 on the throttle
The throttle valves are fully open when the
lever 2 to the fully closed stopper A on
throttle cam roller B is within the range b
the cylinder block and check for clear-
shown in the illustration.
ance a between the throttle cam roller
and the throttle cam.

3-9 63P3F11
Control system
10. Contact the stopper 0 on the throttle Adjusting the throttle link and
lever 2 to the fully closed stopper A on throttle cable operation
the cylinder block and check that throttle (using a thickness gauge)
cam roller B is aligned with the align-
ment mark c.
1. Remove the intake silencer.

2. Loosen the locknut 1, remove the clip


2, and then disconnect the throttle cable
1
joint 3.

B c
3. Contact the stopper 4 on the throttle
lever 2 to the fully closed stopper 5 on
the cylinder block and adjust the throttle
2
link rod joint 6 so that the specified

0
clearance a between the throttle cam
roller and the throttle cam is obtained.

a
3
A

4
S63P3200
6
11. Adjust the position of the throttle cable
joint until its hole is aligned with the set
pin on throttle lever 2.

4
2 1 5
5

d
S63P3210
3

Clearance a: 0.5 mm (0.02 in)


S63P3220

6
CAUTION:
The throttle cable joint must be screwed
in a minimum of 8.0 mm (0.31 in) d.
4. Connect the throttle link rod joint 6, and
then tighten the locknut 7. 7
8
7
12. Connect the cable joint, install the clip,
and then tighten the locknut.

13. Check the throttle cable for smooth oper-


6

9
ation and, if necessary, repeat steps 1–
12.
S63P3230

63P3F11 3-10
CHK
ADJ Periodic checks and adjustments
5. Operate throttle lever 2 to check that the
throttle valves fully close and fully open.

8 d
S63P3210

S63P3240 CAUTION:
The throttle cable joint must be screwed
NOTE: in a minimum of 8.0 mm (0.31 in) d.
The throttle valves are fully open when the
throttle cam roller 8 is within the range b
shown in the illustration. 8. Connect the cable joint, install the clip,
and then tighten the locknut.

6. Contact the stopper 4 on the throttle 9. Check the throttle cable for smooth oper-
lever 2 to the fully closed stopper 5 on ation and, if necessary, repeat steps 1–8.
the cylinder block and check that throttle
cam roller 8 is aligned with the align- Checking the gear shift operation
ment mark c. 1. Check that the gear shift operates
smoothly when shifting it from neutral to
forward or reverse. Adjust the shift cable
length if necessary.

2. Set the gear shift to the neutral position.

8 c 3. Loosen the locknut 1, remove the clip


2, and then disconnect the shift cable
joint 3.

4
5
3
S63P3250 1

7. Adjust the position of the throttle cable


joint until its hole is aligned with the set 2
pin on throttle lever 2.
4 S63P3260

4. Adjust the position of the shift lever until


the pin on the lever is aligned with the
line on the shift position switch plate 4.

5. Align the center of the set pin a with the


alignment mark b on the bottom cowl-
ing.

3-11 63P3F11
Control system

1
1

b
a S63P3270

6. Adjust the position of the shift cable joint


Digital tachometer: 90890-06760
S63P3140

2
until its hole is aligned with the set pin.

3. Attach the special service tool to spark


plug wire #1. 3
c S69J3370
4
CAUTION:
The shift cable joint must be screwed in a
minimum of 8.0 mm (0.31 in) c.
S63P3280 5
Timing light: 90890-03141
7. Connect the cable joint, install the clip,
and then tighten the locknut.

8. Check the gear shift for smooth operation


4. Check that the “TDC” mark a on the fly-
wheel magnet is aligned with the mark b
6
on the pointer.
and, if necessary, repeat steps 3–7.

Checking the ignition timing


1. Start the engine and warm it up for 5 min-
utes. a
7
2. Attach the special service tool to spark
plug wire #1 1, and then check the
engine idle speed.
b 8
S63P3290

Ignition timing at engine idle speed:


TDC 9
63P3F11 3-12
CHK
ADJ Periodic checks and adjustments
Power trim and tilt unit 3

Checking the power trim and tilt WARNING


operation After tilting up the outboard motor, be
sure to support it with the tilt stop lever.
1. Fully tilt the outboard motor up and down
Otherwise, the outboard motor could sud-
a few times and check the entire trim and
denly lower if the power trim and tilt unit
tilt range for smooth operation. Check the
should lose fluid pressure.
power trim and tilt fluid level if necessary.

NOTE:
Be sure to listen to the winding sound of the 2. Remove the reservoir cap 2, and then
power trim and tilt motor for smooth opera- check the fluid level in the reservoir.
tion.

2. Fully tilt the outboard motor up, and then


support it with the tilt stop lever 1 to
check the lock mechanism of the lever.

1 2
S60X3030

NOTE:
If the fluid is at the correct level, the fluid
should overflow out of the filler hole when the
reservoir cap is removed.

3. If necessary, add sufficient fluid of the


recommended type until it overflows out
of the filler hole.
S60X3020

Recommended power trim and tilt


Checking the power trim and tilt fluid fluid:
level ATF Dexron II
1. Fully tilt the outboard motor up, and then
support it with the tilt stop lever 1. 4. Install the reservoir cap, and then tighten
it to the specified torque.
1
Reservoir cap:
0.7 N·m (0.07 kgf·m, 0.5 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Lower unit 3

Checking the gear oil level


1. Fully tilt the outboard motor down.

2. Remove the check screw 1, and then


check the gear oil level in the lower case.

S60X3020

3-13 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit / Lower unit
3. Check the oil for metal and discoloration,
and its viscosity. Check the internal parts
of the lower case if necessary.

4. Insert a gear oil tube or gear oil pump


into the drain hole and slowly fill the gear
oil until oil flows out of the check hole and
1
no air bubbles are visible.
1

NOTE:
S60V3320

If the oil is at the correct level, the oil should


2
overflow out of the check hole when the
check screw is removed.

3. If necessary, add sufficient gear oil of the


3
recommended type until it overflows out
of the check hole.

Recommended gear oil:


Hypoid gear oil
4
SAE: 90

4. Install the check screw.

Changing the gear oil


5
1. Tilt the outboard motor up slightly.

2. Place a drain pan under the drain screw


1, remove the drain screw, then the
check screw 2 and let the oil drain com-
6
pletely.

7
Recommended gear oil:
Hypoid gear oil
SAE: 90
Oil quantity:
Regular rotation model:
980 cm3
(33.1 US oz, 34.6 Imp oz)
Counter rotation model:
870 cm3
8
(29.4 US oz, 30.7 Imp oz)

5. Install the check screw and quickly install


the drain screw.
9
63P3F11 3-14
CHK
ADJ Periodic checks and adjustments
Checking the lower unit for air
leakage
1. Remove the check screw 1, and then
install the special service tool.

S69J3580

General 3

Checking the anodes


1. Check the anodes and trim tab for
scales, grease, or oil. Clean if necessary.
Leakage tester: 90890-06840

2. Apply the specified pressure to check


that the pressure is maintained in the
lower unit for at least 10 seconds.

CAUTION:
Do not over pressurize the lower unit, oth-
erwise the oil seals can be damaged.

NOTE:
Cover the check hole with a rag when remov- S63P3300
ing the tester from the lower unit.

Lower unit holding pressure:


70 kPa (0.7 kgf/cm2, 10 psi)

3. If pressure drops below specification,


check the drive shaft and propeller shaft
oil seals for damage.
S60X3080
Checking the propeller
1. Check the propeller blades and splines
for cracks, damage, or wear. Replace if
necessary.

3-15 63P3F11
Lower unit / General
Batteries generate explosive, hydrogen
CAUTION: gas. Always follow these preventive mea-
Do not oil, grease, or paint the anodes or sures:

1
the trim tab, otherwise they will be ineffec- • Charge batteries in a well-ventilated
tive. area.
• Keep batteries away from fire, sparks or
open flames (e.g., welding equipment,
2. Replace the anodes or trim tab if exces- lighted cigarettes).
sively eroded.

2
• DO NOT SMOKE when charging or han-
dling batteries.
Checking the battery KEEP BATTERIES AND ELECTROLYTE
1. Check the battery electrolyte level. If the OUT OF REACH OF CHILDREN.
level is at or below the minimum level
mark a, add distilled water until the level
is between the maximum and minimum
level marks.
NOTE:
• Batteries vary per manufacturer. The pro-
cedures mentioned in this manual may not
always apply, therefore, consult the instruc-
3
tion manual of the battery.
a • Disconnect the negative battery lead first,
then the positive battery lead. 4
Electrolyte specific gravity:

S69J3620
1.280 at 20 °C (68 °F)

Lubricating the outboard motor


5
2. Check the specific gravity of the electro- 1. Apply water resistant grease to the areas

6
lyte. Fully charge the battery if out of shown.
specification.

WARNING
Battery electrolyte is dangerous; it con-

7
tains sulfuric acid which is poisonous and
highly caustic.
Always follow these preventive measures:
• Avoid bodily contact with electrolyte as
it can cause severe burns or permanent
eye injury.
• Wear protective eye gear when handling
or working near batteries.
Antidote (EXTERNAL):
8
• SKIN – Wash with water.
• EYES – Flush with water for 15 minutes
and get immediate medical attention.
Antidote (INTERNAL):
• Drink large quantities of water or milk A
9
followed with milk of magnesia, beaten
S63P3310
egg, or vegetable oil. Get immediate
medical attention.

63P3F11 3-16
CHK
ADJ Periodic checks and adjustments

NOTE:
Apply grease to the grease nipple until it
flows from the bushings a.

2. Apply low temperature resistant grease


A to the areas shown.

S63P3320

A
C

S63P3340

3. Apply corrosion resistant grease to the


S60X3090
areas shown.

S60X3100

S60X3120

3-17 63P3F11
FUEL

Fuel system

Special service tools .....................................................................................4-1

Hose routing ...................................................................................................4-2


Fuel and blowby hoses..............................................................................4-2
1
Fuel filter, fuel pump, and intake silencer ................................................... 4-3
Checking the fuel pumps ...........................................................................4-7
Disassembling a fuel pump ....................................................................... 4-7
Checking the diaphragm and valves .........................................................4-8
2
Assembling a fuel pump ............................................................................4-8

Intake assembly and vapor separator.......................................................... 4-9


Measuring the fuel pressure .................................................................... 4-13
Checking the pressure regulator ............................................................. 4-13
3
Checking the check valve........................................................................4-14

4
Reducing the fuel pressure...................................................................... 4-15
Checking the vapor separator .................................................................4-15
Synchronizing the throttle valves............................................................. 4-16
Adjusting the throttle position sensor.......................................................4-17
Adjusting the throttle position sensor
(when disassembling or replacing the throttle body) ............................. 4-18

5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11
FUEL
Fuel system
Special service tools 4

Vacuum/pressure pump gauge set Test harness (3 pins)


90890-06756 90890-06793

Fuel pressure gauge


90890-06786

Digital circuit tester


90890-03174

Vacuum gauge
90890-03159

Digital tachometer
90890-06760

4-1 63P3F11
Special service tools / Hose routing
Hose routing 4

Fuel and blowby hoses

1
2
3
4
5
6
7
1
2
3
Blowby hoses
Fuel hose (fuel tank-to-fuel filter)
Fuel hoses (fuel filter-to-fuel pumps)
8
4 Fuel hoses (fuel pumps-to-fuel filter)

9
5 Fuel hose (fuel filter-to-vapor separator)
6 High-pressure fuel hose (vapor separator-to-fuel rail)
7 Fuel hose (pressure regulator-to-fuel cooler)
8 Fuel hose (fuel cooler-to-vapor separator)

63P3F11 4-2
FUEL
Fuel system
Fuel filter, fuel pump, and intake silencer 4

14 13

12
11 6 5
7 6

10
8
9
4

15
3

2
10 N · m (1.0 kgf · m, 7.4 ft · Ib)
T.

1
R.

S63P4070

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Intake assembly 1
2 Bolt 5 M8 × 40 mm
3 Bolt 2 M8 × 20 mm
4 Intake silencer 1
5 Bolt 2 M6 × 45 mm
6 Grommet 4
7 Collar 2
8 Bolt 6 M6 × 20 mm
9 Fuel pump 2
10 Bolt 4 M6 × 30 mm
11 Fuel filter 1
12 Bolt 2 M6 × 30 mm
13 Grommet 2
14 Collar 2
15 Holder 1

4-3 63P3F11
Fuel filter, fuel pump, and intake silencer
4

1
8 7
A

6
1
9

2
4

A
2

8 7

10 9
5
3
4
A

9
3
8
7
6

5
A

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


S63P4080
6
1 Throttle lever 1 1
2
3
4
5
Throttle cam
Throttle lever 2
Throttle link rod
Bolt
1
1
1
1 M6 × 35 mm
7
6 Bolt 2 M6 × 25 mm
7
8
9
10
Collar
Wave washer
Washer
Spring
3
3
3
1
8
9
63P3F11 4-4
FUEL
Fuel system
4

8 N · m (0.8 kgf · m, 5.9 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
7
3
8
4

9 8 N · m (0.8 kgf · m, 5.9 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
1
10

11 2

6
12

13

S63P4040

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Bolt 1 M6 × 14 mm
2 Bracket 1
3 Bolt 1 M6 × 16 mm
4 Washer 1
5 Holder 1
6 Cap 1
7 O-ring 1 Not reusable
8 Fuel filter element 1
9 Float 1
10 Spring 1
11 O-ring 1 Not reusable
12 Cup 1
13 Nut 1

4-5 63P3F11
Fuel filter, fuel pump, and intake silencer
4

4 N · m (0.4 kgf · m, 3.0 ft · Ib)


1
T.
R.
1
13 14

10
11
12
15
2 2
11
12

13
3 3
14

9
4
4
6 8

5
5

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


S63P4050
6
1 Screw 3 ø6 × 35 mm
2
3
4
5
Cover
Fuel pump body 2
Fuel pump body 1
Plunger
1
1
1
1
7
6 Spring 1
7
8
9
10
Nut
Spring
Pin
Diaphragm
3
1
1
1
8
11 Nut 2
12
13
14
15
Spring
Valve
Screw
Gasket
2
2
2
1 Not reusable
9
63P3F11 4-6
FUEL
Fuel system
Checking the fuel pumps 6. Apply the specified positive pressure and
1. Place a drain pan under the fuel hose check that there is no air leakage. Disas-
connections, and then disconnect the semble the fuel pump if necessary.
fuel hoses from the fuel pumps.

2. Connect the special service tool to the


fuel pump inlet.

3. Cover the fuel pump outlet with a finger,


and then apply the specified positive
pressure. Check that there is no air leak-
age.
S63P4110

Specified pressure:
50 kPa (0.5 kgf/cm2, 7.3 psi)

NOTE:
Assemble the fuel pump valve to the fuel
pump body, and moisten the inside of the fuel
pump with gasoline to ensure a good seal.
S63P4090

Vacuum/pressure pump gauge set: Disassembling a fuel pump


90890-06756 1. Disassemble the fuel pump as shown.

Specified pressure:
50 kPa (0.5 kgf/cm2, 7.3 psi)

4. Apply the specified negative pressure


and check that there is no air leakage.

S60C4060

S63P4100

Specified pressure:
30 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.4 psi)

5. Connect the special service tool to the


fuel pump outlet.

4-7 63P3F11
Fuel filter, fuel pump, and intake silencer
2. Push down on the plunger and the dia- Assembling a fuel pump
phragm, turn fuel pump body 1 1
approximately 90° to a position where the NOTE:
pin 2 can be removed easily, and then Clean the parts and soak the valves and the
remove the pin. diaphragm in gasoline before assembly to
obtain prompt operation of the fuel pumps
when starting the engine.
1
1. Align the plunger and diaphragm installa-
tion holes a, and then install the plunger
into the diaphragm.

2. Push down on the plunger and the dia-


2
phragm, and then install the pin 1.

3
4
3. Slowly let up on the plunger and dia-
3. Turn fuel pump body 1 2 approximately
90°, and then push down on the plunger
several times to make sure that the pin
5
phragm, and then remove them.
does not come out.
Checking the diaphragm and valves
1. Check the diaphragm 1 for tears and the
valves 2 for cracks. Replace if neces-
6
sary.

1 2
7
NOTE:
Make sure that the gasket and diaphragm are
kept in place through the assembly process.
8
S60C4090

9
63P3F11 4-8
FUEL
Fuel system
Intake assembly and vapor separator 4

6
7

4
3 8

5 N · m (0.5 kgf · m, 3.7 ft · Ib)


T.
R.

1
9

5 N · m (0.5 kgf · m, 3.7 ft · Ib)


T.
R.

S63P4010

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Bolt 2 M6 × 25 mm
2 Fuel cooler 1
3 Vapor separator 1
4 Fuel hose 1
5 Fuel hose 1
6 Hose 1
7 Electric fuel pump coupler 1
8 Intake assembly 1
9 Bolt 3 M6 × 35 mm

4-9 63P3F11
Intake assembly and vapor separator
4

4
6 7 8
1
5

1
17

2
3
12
2 13
15
14

16
4
9

3 10
5
11

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


S63P4030
6
1 O-ring 1 Not reusable
2
3
4
5
Float chamber
Drain screw
Pressure regulator
Screw
1
1
1
2 M6 × 12 mm
7
6 O-ring 1 Not reusable
7
8
9
10
Cover
Screw
Electric fuel pump
Filter
1
7
1
1
ø4 × 16 mm
8
11 Filter holder 1
12
13
14
15
O-ring
Collar
Needle valve
Screw
1
1
1
1
Not reusable

ø4 × 8 mm
9
16 Float 1
17 Pin 1

63P3F11 4-10
FUEL
Fuel system
4

13 N · m (1.3 kgf · m, 9.6 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
23 22
21
14
10 27 28
24 26
13 N · m (1.3 kgf · m, 9.6 ft · Ib) 15 20
T.
R.

11
25 29
12
13 16

6 8 9
5
4 32
3 33
30
1 17 31

7
8
28
2
27
18

19
2
S63P4020

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Fuel rail 1
2 Bolt 2 M8 × 25 mm
3 O-ring 4 Not reusable
4 Rubber damper 4 Not reusable
5 Fuel injector 4
6 Rubber seal 4 Not reusable
7 Electric fuel pump lead 1
8 Gasket 4 Not reusable
9 Intake manifold 1
10 Screw 2 ø5 × 15 mm
11 Intake air pressure sensor 1
12 O-ring 1 Not reusable
13 O-ring 1 Not reusable
14 Screw 3 ø4 × 15 mm
15 Idle speed control 1
16 O-ring 1 Not reusable
17 Gasket 2 Not reusable

4-11 63P3F11
Intake assembly and vapor separator
4

13 N · m (1.3 kgf · m, 9.6 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
23 22
21
14
10 27 28
24 26
13 N · m (1.3 kgf · m, 9.6 ft · Ib) 15 20

2
T.
R.

11
25 29
12
13 16

3
4
5
6 8 9
32
3
30 33

4
1 17 31

7
8
28
2

18
27
5
19
2

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


S63P4020
6
18 Collar 6
19
20
21
22
Grommet
Bracket
Screw
Screw
3
1
4
2
ø6 × 16 mm
ø4 × 12 mm
7
23 Throttle position sensor 1
24
25
26
27
O-ring
Throttle body #1
Bolt
Bracket
1
1
6
2
Not reusable

M8 × 70 mm
8
28 Screw 4 ø6 × 16 mm
29
30
31
32
Throttle joint link rod
Spring
Throttle body #2
Bracket
1
1
1
1
9
33 Screw 4 ø6 × 16 mm

63P3F11 4-12
FUEL
Fuel system
Measuring the fuel pressure
1. Remove the cap 1. WARNING
• Before measuring the fuel pressure,
2. Connect the fuel pressure gauge to the make sure that the drain screw is tight-
pressure check valve. ened securely.
• Do not loosen the drain screw while
measuring the fuel pressure. Loosening
the drain screw can cause fuel to spray
out creating a fire hazard.
• After measuring the fuel pressure, cover
the end of the hose with a clean, dry rag,
point the hose downward, and then
loosen the drain screw to drain the
1 remaining fuel from the hose and gauge.
S63P4130
• When storing the fuel pressure gauge,
make sure that the drain screw is tight-
Fuel pressure gauge: 90890-06786 ened securely.

WARNING Checking the pressure regulator


1. Remove the cap 1.
• When connecting the fuel pressure
gauge, first cover the connection 2. Connect the fuel pressure gauge to the
between the gauge and the pressure pressure check valve.
check valve with a clean, dry rag to pre-
vent fuel from leaking out. 3. Disconnect the pressure regulator hose,
• Gently screw in the gauge until it is and then connect the special service
firmly connected. tools to the pressure regulator.

3. Turn the engine start switch to ON, and


then measure the fuel pressure within 3
seconds.

NOTE:
The fuel pressure decreases 3 seconds after
the engine start switch is turned to ON. 1
S63P4140

Fuel pressure (reference data):


310 kPa (3.1 kgf/cm2, 45.0 psi) Fuel pressure gauge: 90890-06786
Vacuum/pressure pump gauge set:
4. Start the engine, warm it up for 5 min- 90890-06756
utes, and then measure the fuel pres-
sure. If below specification, check the
high-pressure fuel line and the vapor
separator.

Fuel pressure (reference data):


260 kPa (2.6 kgf/cm2, 37.7 psi)

4-13 63P3F11
Intake assembly and vapor separator

WARNING
• When connecting the fuel pressure

1
gauge, first cover the connection
between the gauge and the pressure
check valve with a clean, dry rag to pre-
vent fuel from leaking out.
• Gently screw in the gauge until it is

2
firmly connected.

4. Start the engine and let it idle.

5. Check that the fuel pressure reduces


when vacuum pressure is applied to the
pressure regulator. If the fuel pressure
does not reduce, replace the pressure
3
regulator.

WARNING
• Before measuring the fuel pressure,
make sure that the drain screw is tight-
Vacuum/pressure pump gauge set:
90890-06756 4
ened securely.
NOTE:

5
• Do not loosen the drain screw while
Check that no air comes out of the opposite
measuring the fuel pressure. Loosening
end of the check valve.
the drain screw can cause fuel to spray
out creating a fire hazard.
• After measuring the fuel pressure, cover
the end of the hose with a clean, dry rag,
point the hose downward, and then
loosen the drain screw to drain the
remaining fuel from the hose and gauge.
6
• When storing the fuel pressure gauge,
make sure that the drain screw is tight-
ened securely.
7
Checking the check valve
1. Connect the special service tool to the
check valve.

2. Apply pressure to each check valve port.


8
Replace if necessary.

9
63P3F11 4-14
FUEL
Fuel system
Reducing the fuel pressure Checking the vapor separator
1. Remove the cap 1. 1. Check the needle valve for bends or
wear. Replace if necessary.
2. Cover the pressure check valve a of the
fuel rail with a rag, and then press in the
pressure check valve a using a thin
screwdriver to release the fuel pressure.

a
2. Check the float for deterioration. Replace
if necessary.
S63P4160

WARNING
Always reduce the fuel pressure in the
high-pressure fuel line before servicing
the line or the vapor separator. If the fuel
pressure is not released, pressurized fuel
may spray out.
S63P4180

3. Place a container under the vapor sepa-


rator drain hose, and then loosen the 3. Check the filter for dirt or residue. Clean
drain screw 2. if necessary.

4. Remove the cap 3.

5. Drain the fuel from the vapor separator


drain hose by pressing the valve using a
thin screwdriver.

S63P4190

4-15 63P3F11
Intake assembly and vapor separator
Synchronizing the throttle valves
NOTE:
CAUTION: For best results, use a vacuum gauge (com-
mercially available), like 2 or 3 shown in the

1
Do not adjust the throttle valve when it is
illustration, that has four adapters.
operating properly. Excess adjustment
may cause poor engine performance.
2. Start the engine and warm it up for 5 min-
1. Remove the caps 1, and then attach the utes.

2
special service tool to the intake manifold
as shown. 3. Attach the special service tool to spark
plug wire #1 4, and then check the
engine idle speed.

1
4
3
S63P4250
4
Digital tachometer: 90890-06760
5
S63P4210 Engine idle speed: 700 ± 50 r/min

Vacuum gauge: 90890-03159 4. Check the vacuum pressure of all cylin-


ders.
6
2

1
7
3
8
9
S63P4220

63P3F11 4-16
FUEL
Fuel system
5. Turn the synchronizing screw 5 so that 1. Remove the intake silencer.
the vacuum pressure of cylinder #3 or #4
is within 4 kPa (30 mmHg) based on the 2. Disconnect the throttle joint link rod 1
vacuum pressure of cylinder #1 or #2. from the throttle lever 1.

b a
5

S63P4230 S63P4260

3. Check that the throttle valves are in the


Vacuum pressure is
Direction a fully closed position.
increase.
Vacuum pressure is
Direction b
decrease.

Example
Check results:
Cylinder #1 #2 #3 #4
kPa 49 48 45 44
(mmHg) (370) (360) (340) (330)
S63P4270
Adjust the difference of the vacuum pressure
between cylinders #1 and #4 within 4 kPa (30 4. Connect the test harness (3 pins) to the
mmHg). throttle position sensor.

Check results:
Cylinder #1 #2 #3 #4
kPa 49 48 52 53
(mmHg) (370) (360) (390) (400)
Adjust the difference of the vacuum pressure
between cylinders #2 and #4 within 4 kPa (30
mmHg).
S63P8130

Adjusting the throttle position


sensor Test harness (3 pins): 90890-06793

NOTE:
• Be sure to adjust the throttle valve’s open- 5. Turn the engine start switch to ON.
ing before measuring the throttle position
sensor output voltage. 6. Measure the throttle position sensor out-
• When measuring the throttle position sen- put voltage with the throttle valves fully
sor output voltage, set the digital tester to closed. If the output voltage is out of
the manual range. specification, adjust the throttle position
sensor.

4-17 63P3F11
Intake assembly and vapor separator

NOTE:
To measure the output voltage, connect the
positive tester probe to the pink wire of the
test harness and the negative tester probe to
the orange wire of the test harness.

1
1
Digital circuit tester: 90890-03174

Throttle position sensor output


S63P4280

4. Loosen the throttle stop screw 2 and


2
voltage: fully close the throttle valves #1 and #2.

3
Pink (P) – Black (B)
0.70 ± 0.02 V

7. Install the intake silencer. 2

8. Start the engine and measure the throttle


position sensor output voltage again.
Adjust the throttle position sensor if out of
specification.
S63P4240
4
Throttle position sensor output
voltage at engine idle speed:
Pink (P) – Black (B)
0.70 ± 0.02 V
5. Turn the engine start switch to ON.

6. Loosen the throttle position sensor screw


and adjust the throttle position sensor
5
output voltage to specification.
Adjusting the throttle position
sensor (when disassembling or
replacing the throttle body)
Throttle position sensor output
voltage:
Pink (P) – Black (B)
6
1. Install the intake assembly.
0.70 ± 0.02 V
2. Connect the test harness (3 pins) to the
throttle position sensor. 7. Operate the throttle valves several times. 7
8. Slowly tighten the synchronizing screw
and stop when the throttle position sen-
sor output voltage begins to change.

9. Tighten the throttle stop screw until it


8
lightly contacts the throttle body lever.

S63P8130
10. Operate the throttle valves several times
and make sure that the throttle position
sensor output voltage does not change.
9
Test harness (3 pins): 90890-06793 11. Tighten the throttle position sensor
screw.
3. Loosen the synchronizing screw 1.

63P3F11 4-18
FUEL
Fuel system
12. Install the throttle joint link rod 3 so the
throttle cam roller 4 is aligned with the
alignment mark a as shown.

a
3

S63P4290

NOTE:
Make sure that the throttle position sensor
output voltage does not change when install-
ing the throttle joint link rod.

13. Install the intake silencer.

14. Start the engine and measure the throttle


position sensor output voltage. Adjust the
throttle position sensor again if out of
specification.

Throttle position sensor output


voltage at engine idle speed:
Pink (P) – Black (B)
0.70 ± 0.02 V

15. Check the throttle valve is synchronized.

4-19 63P3F11
Intake assembly and vapor separator

— MEMO —

1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11 4-20
POWR

Power unit

Special service tools .....................................................................................5-1

Power unit....................................................................................................... 5-3


Checking the compression pressure .......................................................5-11
Checking the oil pressure ........................................................................5-11
Checking the oil pressure sensor ............................................................ 5-12
Checking the valve clearance.................................................................. 5-12
Replacing the timing belt .........................................................................5-16
Removing the power unit.........................................................................5-18
Removing the oil filter .............................................................................. 5-20
Removing the timing belt and sprockets.................................................. 5-20
Checking the timing belt and sprockets...................................................5-21
Installing the sprockets and timing belt....................................................5-21

Cylinder head ...............................................................................................5-23


Removing the cylinder head .................................................................... 5-28
Checking the valve springs...................................................................... 5-28
Checking the valves ................................................................................ 5-29
Checking the valve guides....................................................................... 5-29
Replacing the valve guides...................................................................... 5-30
Checking the valve seat ..........................................................................5-31
Refacing the valve seat ...........................................................................5-31
Checking the camshaft ............................................................................5-33
Checking the cylinder head ..................................................................... 5-34
Installing the valves ................................................................................. 5-34
Installing the cylinder head ...................................................................... 5-35
Removing the exhaust cover ................................................................... 5-37
Checking the pressure control valve .......................................................5-37
Installing the pressure control valve ........................................................ 5-37

63P3F11
Cylinder block ..............................................................................................5-38
Disassembling the cylinder block ............................................................ 5-41
Checking the balancer assembly............................................................. 5-41
Checking the piston diameter .................................................................. 5-41
Checking the cylinder bore ...................................................................... 5-42
Checking the piston clearance ................................................................5-42
Checking the piston rings ........................................................................5-42
Checking the piston ring grooves ............................................................ 5-43
1
Checking the piston ring side clearance.................................................. 5-43
Checking the connecting rod big end side clearance ..............................5-43
Checking the crankshaft ..........................................................................5-44
Checking the crankpin oil clearance........................................................ 5-45
Selecting the connecting rod bearing ......................................................5-46
2
Checking the crankshaft main journal oil clearance ................................5-47
Selecting the crankshaft main bearing ....................................................5-48
Disassembling the oil pump..................................................................... 5-49
Checking the oil pump ............................................................................. 5-49
Assembling the oil pump .........................................................................5-49
3
Assembling the pistons and cylinder block.............................................. 5-50

4
Installing the power unit...........................................................................5-55

5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11
POWR
Power unit
Special service tools 5

Compression gauge Flywheel puller


90890-03160 90890-06521

Compression gauge extension Valve spring compressor


90890-06563 90890-04019

Test harness (3 pins) Valve spring compressor attachment


New: 90890-06869 90890-06320
Current: 90890-06769

Valve guide remover/installer


Flywheel holder 90890-06801
90890-06522

Valve guide installer


Oil filter wrench 90890-06810
90890-06830

5-1 63P3F11
Special service tools

1
Valve guide reamer Piston ring compressor
90890-06804 90890-05158

2
Valve seat cutter holder
3
90890-06316

4
Valve seat cutter
5
90890-06324, 90890-06325, 90890-06326,
90890-06327

6
Needle bearing attachment
7
90890-06611, 90890-06654

8
Driver rod L3
90890-06652
9
63P3F11 5-2
POWR
Power unit
Power unit 5

1 8 N · m (0.8 kgf · m, 5.9 ft · Ib) 13

T.
R.
2 5

7
3 6

12
4

LT
E LT 572
10
572
11

42 N · m (4.2 kgf · m, 31.0 ft · Ib)


T.
R.

8 8 14
15

16
20 N · m (2.0 kgf · m, 14.8 ft · Ib)
9
T.
R.

4 N · m (0.4 kgf · m, 3.0 ft · Ib)


T.
R.

S63P5560

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Dipstick 1
2 Bolt 1 M6 × 20 mm
3 Dipstick guide 1
4 O-ring 1 Not reusable
5 Flywheel magnet cover 1
6 Power unit 1
7 Spark plug wire cover 1
8 Dowel 2
9 Gasket 1 Not reusable
10 Bolt 4 M10 × 35 mm
11 Bolt 8 M10 × 140 mm
12 Bolt 3 M8 × 35 mm
13 Bolt 4 M6 × 16 mm
14 Apron 1
15 Screw 2 ø6 × 40 mm
16 Nut 2

5-3 63P3F11
Power unit
5

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Nut 1
2
3
4
5
Washer
Flywheel magnet
Bolt
Holder
1
1
4
1
M6 × 35 mm 7
6 Bracket 2
7
8
9
10
Collar
Holder
Stator coil bracket
Hose
2
1
1
1
8
11 Plastic tie 1 Not reusable
12
13
14
Woodruff key
Stator coil
Screw
1
1
4 ø6 × 30 mm
9
63P3F11 5-4
POWR
Power unit
5

1
2 29 N · m (2.9 kgf · m, 21.4 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
8

9
10
3 9
4
8
11
5 12
9 N · m (0.9 kgf · m, 6.6 ft · Ib)
13
T.
R.

14 7 N · m (0.7 kgf · m, 5.2 ft · Ib)


7
T.
R.

6
18 N · m (1.8 kgf · m, 13.3 ft · Ib)
T.
R.

4 N · m (0.4 kgf · m, 3.0 ft · Ib) S63P5580


T.
R.

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Starter motor 1
2 Bolt 3 M8 × 45 mm
3 Terminal 1
4 Nut 1
5 Cap 1
6 Bolt 1 M6 × 10 mm
7 Starter motor lead 1
8 Ignition coil 2
9 Holder 2
10 Holder 1
11 Bracket 2
12 Holder 2
13 Bolt 4 M6 × 25 mm
14 Oil filter 1

5-5 63P3F11
Power unit
5

2
3

4
2
1 3

8
7
1
6

4
2
9

1
5
4
3
10

7
13
12
11 4
9 9

10

11
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
S63P5600
6
1 Grommet 1
2
3
4
5
Fuse holder
Terminal plate
Terminal
Terminal
1
4
8
8
7
6 Fuse holder 1
7
8
9
10
Fuse
Screw
Fuse
Relay
2
4
2
1
50 A
ø5 × 10 mm
20 A
8
11 Fuse 1 30 A
12
13
Screw
Screw
6
3
ø3 × 10 mm
ø5 × 20 mm
9
63P3F11 5-6
POWR
Power unit
5

29 2
26
27
28

24

1
25 3 4

16
17 5
22 23
9

21
20
11 67
10 8
6
7
19 8 18

12
15 13
14

4 N · m (0.4 kgf · m, 3.0 ft · Ib)


T.
R.

S63P5610

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Junction box 1
2 ECM 1
3 Bolt 4 M6 × 16 mm
4 Wiring harness 1
5 Bolt 1 M6 × 20 mm
6 Washer 2
7 Nut 2
8 Cap 2
9 Power trim and tilt relay 1
10 Bolt 2 M6 × 20 mm
11 Starter relay 1
12 Holder 1
13 Bolt 1 M6 × 10 mm
14 Cap 1
15 Screw 1 ø6 × 19 mm
16 Grommet 1
17 Plastic tie 2 Not reusable

5-7 63P3F11
Power unit
5

29
26
27
28
2
1
24

25
1
3 4
2
16

22 23
9
17 5

3
4
21
20
11 67
10 8
6
7
8 18

5
19

12
15 13
14

4 N · m (0.4 kgf · m, 3.0 ft · Ib)

6
T.
R.

S63P5610

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Holder 1
19
20
21
22
Bolt
Intake air temperature sensor
Grommet
Screw
1
1
1
1
M6 × 12 mm

ø6 × 19 mm
7
23 Bracket 1
24
25
26
27
Screw
Holder
Collar
Grommet
1
1
3
3
ø6 × 19 mm

8
28 Bolt 3 M6 × 35 mm
29 Wiring harness 1

9
63P3F11 5-8
POWR
Power unit
5

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Timing belt 1
2 Timing belt tensioner 1
3 Bolt 4 M5 × 40 mm
4 Drive sprocket 1
5 Plate 1
6 Woodruff key 1
7 Bolt 2 M10 × 35 mm
8 Driven sprocket 2
9 Oil seal 2
10 Dowel 2
11 Camshaft 1
12 Camshaft 1
13 Camshaft cap 2
14 Camshaft cap 8
15 Bolt 4 M7 × 48 mm
16 Bolt 16 M7 × 37 mm
17 Gasket 1 Not reusable

5-9 63P3F11
Power unit
5

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
18 Screw 8 ø4 × 8 mm
19
20
21
22
Plate
Grommet
Cylinder head cover
Bolt
1
6
1
15 M6 × 30 mm
7
23 Holder 2
24
25
26
27
Bolt
Clamp
Hose
Dowel
2
2
1
4
M6 × 10 mm

8
28 Dowel 1

9
63P3F11 5-10
POWR
Power unit
Checking the compression pressure
NOTE:
1. Start the engine, warm it up for 5 min-
• If the compression pressure increases,
utes, and then turn it off.
check the pistons and piston rings for wear.
2. Remove the engine stop lanyard from the Replace if necessary.
engine stop lanyard switch on the remote • If the compression pressure does not
control box. increase, check the valve clearance, valve,
valve seat, cylinder sleeve, cylinder head
3. Remove the spark plug wire cover and all gasket, and cylinder head. Adjust or
spark plugs, and then install the special replace if necessary.
service tools into a spark plug hole.
Checking the oil pressure
1. Place a rag under the oil pressure sen-
2 sor.

2. Remove the oil pressure sensor, and


then install an oil pressure gauge 1 to
1 the oil pressure sensor installation hole.

S63P5010
1
CAUTION:
Before removing the spark plugs, blow
compressed air in the spark plug well to
clear out any dirt or dust that may fall into
the cylinder.
S63P5020

Compression gauge 1:
NOTE:
90890-03160 Use a general pressure gauge.
Compression gauge extension 2:
90890-06563
3. Start the engine and warm it up for 5 min-
4. Fully open the throttle, crank the engine utes.
until the reading on the compression
gauge stabilizes, and then check the 4. Check the oil pressure. Check the oil
compression pressure. pump, oil leakage, and oil strainer if out
of specification.
Minimum compression pressure
(reference data): Oil pressure (reference data):
880 kPa (8.8 kgf/cm2, 128 psi) 450 kPa (4.5 kgf/cm2, 65.3 psi) at
engine idle speed
5. If the compression pressure is below
specification and the compression pres-
sure for each cylinder is unbalanced, add
a small amount of engine oil to the cylin-
der, and then check the pressure again.

5-11 63P3F11
Power unit
Checking the oil pressure sensor Checking the valve clearance
1. Connect the test harness (3 pins) to the 1. Remove the flywheel magnet cover and
oil pressure sensor. spark plug wire cover.

2. Start the engine and warm it up for 5 min-


utes.
2. Disconnect the fuel hoses from the fuel
pumps. 1
3. Measure the oil pressure sensor input 3. Disconnect the spark plug wires 1, and
remove the blowby hoses 2, spark

2
voltage. Check the wiring harness con-
nection or replace the ECM if out of spec- plugs, and cylinder head cover 3.
ification.

4. Measure the oil pressure sensor output


2

3
voltage. Replace if out of specification. 2

1 S63P5050

4. Turn the flywheel magnet clockwise and


4
align the “TDC” mark a on the flywheel
magnet with the pointer b, and check

5
S63P5030

that “I” marks c and d on the driven


sprockets are aligned.
2.8 V
c d
a

b 450 kpa
6
(4.5 kgf/cm2,

7
65.3 psi) S63P5040

a: Output voltage
b: Oil pressure

Test harness (3 pins):


New: 90890-06869
Current: 90890-06769

Oil pressure sensor input voltage:


20
a
10 TDC
-10

b
8
Orange (O) – Black (B)
5V
Oil pressure sensor output voltage
(reference data):
Pink/white (P/W) – Black (B)
NOTE:
Do not turn the flywheel magnet counter-
S63P5060

9
clockwise.
2.8 V at engine idle speed

63P3F11 5-12
POWR
Power unit
5. Check the intake valve clearance for cyl- 9. Using a hexagon wrench, turn the timing
inders #1 and #2, and exhaust valve belt tensioner 4 clockwise to push the
clearance for cylinders #1 and #3. Adjust timing belt, increase strength gradually,
if out of specification. and then insert a ø5.0 mm (0.2 in) pin 5
into the hole g.
6. Turn the flywheel magnet 360° clock-
wise. NOTE:
Leave the pin inserted into the timing belt
7. Check the intake valve clearance for cyl- tensioner until the timing belt has been
inders #3 and #4, and exhaust valve installed.
clearance for cylinders #2 and #4. Adjust
if out of specification.
10. Remove the timing belt 6 from the
EX IN driven sprockets.

6
#1

#2 5
#3

#4
4 g
S63P5080

11. Remove the driven sprockets.


e f

S63P5070

NOTE:
• Check the valve clearance when the engine
is cold.
• Note the measurement. S63P5090

NOTE:
Valve clearance:
Hold the camshaft using a wrench, and be
Intake e:
careful not to damage the driven sprocket.
0.20 ± 0.03 mm (0.008 ± 0.001 in)
Exhaust f:
0.34 ± 0.03 mm (0.013 ± 0.001 in) 12. Remove the camshaft caps in the order
shown in the illustration.
8. Turn the flywheel magnet 360° clockwise
and align the “TDC” mark on the flywheel
magnet with the pointer, and check that
the “I” marks on the driven sprockets are
aligned.

5-13 63P3F11
Power unit
17. Install the necessary valve shim into the
1 1 valve lifter.
5 5
18. Install the camshafts into the cylinder
2
4
2

4
head with new oil seals.
1
3 3 E

13. Remove the camshafts.


S63P5100 E

63P EX
63P IN

2
M
14. Remove the valve shim 7 from the valve
lifter 8 using compressed air. S63P5110

3
4
NOTE:
Do not mix the valve train parts. Keep them
NOTE:
S63P5C70

Install the camshafts so that the dowels are


5
organized in their proper groups. facing inward and that they are aligned with

15. Measure the valve shim thickness using


a micrometer, and then note the mea-
the mating surface of the cylinder head.
6
surement.

16. Select the necessary valve shim by cal-


culating its thickness using the following
formula.
7
Necessary valve shim thickness =
Removed valve shim thickness +
Measured valve clearance – Specified
valve clearance
8
9
Example:
If the “Removed valve shim thickness” is 2.10
mm, the “Measured valve clearance” is 0.30
mm and the “Specified valve clearance” is
0.20 mm, then the “Necessary valve shim
thickness” = 2.10 + 0.30 – 0.20 = 2.20 mm

63P3F11 5-14
POWR
Power unit
19. Install the camshaft caps, and then 21. Check that “I” marks c and d on the
tighten them to the specified torques in driven sprockets are aligned. Adjust if
two stages and in the sequence shown in necessary.
the illustration.
c d
2

E E

56 51
17 12
S63P5140
48 43
29 24 22. Install the timing belt 6, turn the belt
from the drive sprocket side a half turn
3 3
10 5 counterclockwise to align it, and then
S63P5120 remove the pin 5.

NOTE: 6
• Install the camshaft caps in the proper posi-
tion as shown and with the stamped num- 5
bers facing upside down.
• Apply engine oil to the camshaft cap bolts
before installation.

Camshaft cap bolt: S63P5C90


1st: 8 N·m (0.8 kgf·m, 5.9 ft·lb)
T.
R.

2nd: 17 N·m (1.7 kgf·m, 12.5 ft·lb) 23. Turn the flywheel magnet clockwise two
turns, and then check that all alignment
20. Install the driven sprockets, and then marks are aligned.
tighten the bolts to the specified torque.

S63P5130

NOTE:
Apply engine oil to the driven sprocket bolts
-10

before installation. 20 10 TDC

Driven sprocket bolt:


S63P5160
60 N·m (6.0 kgf·m, 44.3 ft·lb)
T.
R.

5-15 63P3F11
Power unit

NOTE: c d
Do not turn the flywheel magnet counter-
clockwise.

24. Check the valve clearances. Adjust if


necessary.
1
25. Install the spark plugs, and then tighten
them to the specified torque.

26. Install the cylinder head cover bolts, and


2
then tighten them to the specified torques
a
in two stages.

Spark plug:
25 N·m (2.5 kgf·m, 18.4 ft·lb)
20 10 TDC
-10

b 3
T.
R.

Cylinder head cover bolt: S63P5060

1st: 8 N·m (0.8 kgf·m, 5.9 ft·lb)


2nd: 8 N·m (0.8 kgf·m, 5.9 ft·lb)

27. Install the blowby hoses, and connect the


NOTE:
Do not turn the flywheel magnet counter-
clockwise.
4
spark plug caps.

28. Install the spark plug wire cover and fly-


wheel magnet cover.
3. Loosen the flywheel magnet nut.
5
Replacing the timing belt
1. Remove the flywheel magnet cover.

2. Turn the flywheel magnet clockwise and


align the “TDC” mark a on the flywheel
6
magnet with the pointer b, and check
that “I” marks c and d on the driven
sprockets are aligned.
CAUTION:
7
Apply force in the direction of the arrows
shown to prevent the flywheel holder from
slipping off easily.
8
Flywheel holder: 90890-06522

9
63P3F11 5-16
POWR
Power unit
4. Remove the flywheel magnet. 6. Using a hexagon wrench, turn the timing
belt tensioner 5 clockwise to push the
timing belt, increase strength gradually,
and then insert a ø5.0 mm (0.2 in) pin 6
into the hole e.

NOTE:
Leave the pin inserted into the timing belt
tensioner until the timing belt has been
installed.

7. Remove the timing belt 7 from the


driven sprocket side.

CAUTION: 5 e
S63P5310
To prevent damage to the engine or tools,
screw in the puller set bolts evenly and 8. Check that “I” marks c and d on the
completely so that the puller plate is par- driven sprockets are aligned, and that the
allel to the flywheel magnet. “ ” mark f on the plate is aligned with
the “I” mark g on the cylinder block.
NOTE: Align if necessary.
Apply force to the crankshaft end until the fly-
wheel magnet comes off the tapered portion c d
of the crankshaft.

Flywheel puller: 90890-06521

g
5. Disconnect the stator coil coupler 1 and f
pulser coil coupler 2, and remove the
blowby hose 3 and stator assembly 4.

S63P5320

5-17 63P3F11
Power unit
9. Install a new timing belt 7 from the drive
sprocket side with its part number in the
upright position, turn the belt a half turn

1
counterclockwise to align it, and then
remove the pin 6.

13. Install the flywheel magnet.


2
S63P5330

3
4
CAUTION:

CAUTION:
Apply force in the direction of the arrows
shown to prevent the flywheel holder from
slipping off easily.
5
• Do not twist, turn inside out, or bend the
timing belt beyond the maximum limit of
25 mm (1.0 in) h, otherwise it can be
damaged.
• Do not get oil or grease on the timing
NOTE:
Apply engine oil to the flywheel magnet nut
before installation.
6
belt.

10. Turn the drive sprocket clockwise two


turns, and then check that all alignment
Flywheel holder: 90890-06522
7
marks are aligned. Flywheel magnet nut:

8
270 N·m (27.0 kgf·m, 199.1 ft·lb)
T.
R.

NOTE:
Do not turn the drive sprocket counterclock- 14. Install the flywheel magnet cover.
wise.
Removing the power unit
11. Install the stator assembly, and blowby
hose, and connect the pulser coil coupler
and stator coil coupler.
NOTE:
It is recommended to loosen the flywheel
magnet nut before removing the power unit to
9
improve working efficiency.
12. Install the Woodruff key.
1. Remove the flywheel magnet cover.

63P3F11 5-18
POWR
Power unit
2. Disconnect the battery leads 1.

6
1
S63P5420

S63P5380
7. Disconnect the PTT switch coupler, shift
3. Disconnect the throttle cable 2 and shift cut switch coupler, neutral switch cou-
cable 3. pler, cooling water pilot hose, and flush-
ing hose.

3 2 8. Remove the apron 7.

S63P5390

7
4. Remove the junction box cover, and then
disconnect the PTT motor leads 4. S63P5430

9. Remove the power unit by removing the


bolts 8.

S63P5400

5. Disconnect the fuel hose 5.

8
8 8 S63P5440

10. Remove the flywheel magnet.


5
S63P5410

6. Remove the dipstick guide 6.

5-19 63P3F11
Power unit

NOTE:
Be sure to clean up any oil spills.

Oil filter wrench: 90890-06830 1


Removing the timing belt and
sprockets
1. Turn the drive sprocket clockwise and
align the “ ” mark a on the plate with
2
the “I” mark b on the cylinder block, and
check that “I” marks c and d on the
driven sprockets are aligned.

c d
3
CAUTION:
4
To prevent damage to the engine or tools,

5
screw in the puller set bolts evenly and b
completely so that the puller plate is par- a
allel to the flywheel magnet.

NOTE:
Apply force to the crankshaft end until the fly-
wheel magnet comes off the tapered portion
of the crankshaft.
6
S63P5450

Flywheel puller: 90890-06521

Removing the oil filter


NOTE:
Do not turn the drive sprocket counterclock-
wise.
7
1. Place a rag under the oil filter, and then
remove the filter using a 72.5 mm (2.9 in)
oil filter wrench. 8
9
63P3F11 5-20
POWR
Power unit
2. Using a hexagon wrench, turn the timing Checking the timing belt and
belt tensioner 1 clockwise to push the sprockets
timing belt, increase strength gradually, 1. Check the interior and exterior of the tim-
and then insert a ø5.0 mm (0.2 in) pin 2 ing belt for cracks, damage, or wear.
into the hole e. Replace if necessary.

3. Remove the timing belt 3 from the


driven sprocket side.

1 e 2. Check the drive sprocket 1 and driven


S63P5460
sprockets 2 for cracks, damage, or
wear. Replace if necessary.
4. Remove the timing belt tensioner.

NOTE:
Do not remove the pin 2 from the timing belt
tensioner.

5. Remove the drive sprocket and plate.

6. Remove the cylinder head cover, and


then remove the driven sprockets.

Installing the sprockets and timing


belt
1. Install the driven sprockets 1, and then
tighten the bolts to the specified torque.

2. Check that “I” marks a and b on the


driven sprockets are aligned.

S63P5090 3. Install a new gasket and the cylinder


head cover 2, and then tighten the bolts
NOTE: to the specified torques in two stages.
Hold the camshaft using a wrench, and be
careful not to damage the driven sprocket.

5-21 63P3F11
Power unit

Drive sprocket bolt:


7 N·m (0.7 kgf·m, 5.2 ft·lb)

T.
a b

R.
Timing belt tensioner bolt:
39 N·m (3.9 kgf·m, 28.8 ft·lb)

6. Install the timing belt 5 from the drive


1
sprocket side with its part number in the
2 S1280B 1 E

2
upright position, turn the belt a half turn
counterclockwise to align it, and then
remove the pin 6.

6
3
S63P5470

Driven sprocket bolt:


60 N·m (6.0 kgf·m, 44.3 ft·lb) 4
T.

S63P5150
R.

Cylinder head cover bolt:


1st: 8 N·m (0.8 kgf·m, 5.9 ft·lb) 7. Turn the drive sprocket clockwise two
2nd: 8 N·m (0.8 kgf·m, 5.9 ft·lb)

4. Install the drive sprocket 3 and timing


belt tensioner 4, and then tighten the
turns, and then check that the alignment
marks are aligned.
5
bolts to the specified torques.

5. Check that the “ ” mark c on the plate


is aligned with the “I” mark d on the cyl-
inder block. Align if necessary.
6
7
8
S63P5500

NOTE:
Do not turn the drive sprocket counterclock-
wise.
9
63P3F11 5-22
POWR
Power unit
Cylinder head 5

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Bolt 10 M8 × 55 mm
2 Valve shim 16
3 Valve lifter 16
4 Valve cotter 32
5 Valve spring retainer 16
6 Valve spring 16
7 Valve seal 16 Not reusable
8 Valve guide 16 Not reusable
9 Bolt 10 M10 × 120 mm
10 Spark plug 4
11 Bolt 2 M8 × 40 mm
12 Bolt 2 M6 × 20 mm
13 Cover 2
14 Grommet 2
15 Anode 2
16 Cylinder head 1
17 Exhaust valve 8

5-23 63P3F11
Cylinder head
5

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
18 Intake valve 8
19
20
21
22
Gasket
Collar
Anode
Screw
1
2
1
3
Not reusable

ø6 × 16 mm
7
23 Anode 2

8
9
63P3F11 5-24
POWR
Power unit
5

23 N · m (2.3 kgf · m, 17.0 ft · Ib)


T.
R.

4 12 N · m (1.2 kgf · m, 8.9 ft · Ib)


8

T.
R.
44 5 9 1 6 N · m (0.6 kgf · m, 4.4 ft · lb)
45 12 N · m (1.2 kgf · m, 8.9 ft · lb)

T.
2

R.
17
23 N · m (2.3 kgf · m, 17.0 ft · Ib)
7 15

T.
16

R.
6 E
18
1 2 19 20
21

15 N · m (1.5 kgf · m, 11.1 ft · Ib) 24 25


T.
R.

22
4746 A
23
LT
47 46 572
26
32 33
4746
27 28
40 29 30
31 35
10 47 41
11 46 A LT 34
E 271
12 47 36
3 46 37
42 43 38
E
34 LT
39
55 N · m (5.5 kgf · m, 40.6 ft · Ib) 572
T.
R.

13 34 N · m (3.4 kgf · m, 25.1 ft · Ib) 35


12
T.
R.

18 N · m (1.8 kgf · m, 13.3 ft · Ib) 14 S63P5630


T.
R.

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Engine temperature sensor 1
2 Washer 1
3 Bolt 1
4 Plug 1 M14 × 12 mm
5 Washer 1
6 Engine hanger 1
7 Bolt 2 M6 × 20 mm
8 Bolt 1 M6 × 16 mm
9 Bracket 1
10 O-ring 1 Not reusable
11 Oil pressure sensor 1
12 O-ring 2 Not reusable
13 Oil filter bracket 1
14 Bolt 4 M6 × 40 mm
15 Gasket 1 Not reusable
16 Exhaust cover 1
17 Bolt 19 M6 × 30 mm

5-25 63P3F11
Cylinder head
5

23 N · m (2.3 kgf · m, 17.0 ft · Ib)


T.

1
R.

4 12 N · m (1.2 kgf · m, 8.9 ft · Ib)


8

T.
R.
44 5 9 1 6 N · m (0.6 kgf · m, 4.4 ft · lb)
45 12 N · m (1.2 kgf · m, 8.9 ft · lb)

T.
2

R.
17
23 N · m (2.3 kgf · m, 17.0 ft · Ib)
7 15

T.
16

R.
6 E

1 2
18
19 20
21 2
15 N · m (1.5 kgf · m, 11.1 ft · Ib) 24 25
T.
R.

3
22
4746 A
23
LT
47 46 572
26
32 33

4
4746
27 28
40 29 30
31 35
10 47 41
11 46 A LT 34
E

5
271
12 47 36
3 46 37
42 43 38
E
34 LT
39
55 N · m (5.5 kgf · m, 40.6 ft · Ib) 572
T.
R.

13 35

6
12 34 N · m (3.4 kgf · m, 25.1 ft · Ib)
T.
R.

18 N · m (1.8 kgf · m, 13.3 ft · Ib) 14 S63P5630


T.
R.

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Gasket 1 Not reusable
19
20
21
22
Thermostat
Cover
Thermoswitch
Holder
1
1
1
1
7
23 Bolt 3 M6 × 30 mm
24
25
26
27
Gasket
Rectifier Regulator
Bolt
Anode
1
1
6
1
Not reusable

M6 × 30 mm
8
28 Grommet 1
29
30
31
32
Cover
Bolt
Bolt
Washer
1
1
1
1
M8 × 40 mm
M6 × 20 mm
9
33 Plug 1 M14 × 12 mm
34 Grommet 1

63P3F11 5-26
POWR
Power unit
5

23 N · m (2.3 kgf · m, 17.0 ft · Ib)


T.
R.

4 12 N · m (1.2 kgf · m, 8.9 ft · Ib)


8

T.
R.
44 5 9 1 6 N · m (0.6 kgf · m, 4.4 ft · lb)
45 12 N · m (1.2 kgf · m, 8.9 ft · lb)

T.
2

R.
17
23 N · m (2.3 kgf · m, 17.0 ft · Ib)
7 15

T.
16

R.
6 E
18
1 2 19 20
21

15 N · m (1.5 kgf · m, 11.1 ft · Ib) 24 25


T.
R.

22
4746 A
23
LT
47 46 572
26
32 33
4746
27 28
40 29 30
31 35
10 47 41
11 46 A LT 34
E 271
12 47 36
3 46 37
42 43 38
E
34 LT
39
55 N · m (5.5 kgf · m, 40.6 ft · Ib) 572
T.
R.

13 34 N · m (3.4 kgf · m, 25.1 ft · Ib) 35


12
T.
R.

18 N · m (1.8 kgf · m, 13.3 ft · Ib) 14 S63P5630


T.
R.

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


35 Pressure control valve 1
36 Spring 1
37 Gasket 1 Not reusable
38 Cover 1
39 Bolt 3 M6 × 20 mm
40 Washer 1
41 Plug 1 M18 × 17 mm
42 Holder 1
43 Bolt 1 M6 × 12 mm
44 Anode 1
45 Screw 1
46 Anode 7
47 Screw 7 ø5 × 27 mm

5-27 63P3F11
Cylinder head
Removing the cylinder head 4. Remove the intake valve and exhaust
1. Remove the camshaft caps in the valves.
sequence shown.

1
5
1
5
1
2 2

4
3
4
3 2
S63P5100

2. Remove the camshafts and cylinder


head bolts in the sequence shown.

B
3
4 A
6
8
0
J
F E

I
NOTE:
4
9G H Be sure to keep the valves, springs, and
7

5
other parts in the order as they were
5 D removed.
C
1 2 3 S63P5170

CAUTION: Valve spring compressor 3:


90890-04019
Do not scratch or damage the mating sur-
faces of the cylinder head and cylinder
block.
Valve spring compressor
attachment 4:
90890-06320
6
3. Remove the valve shim 1 from the valve
lifter 2 using compressed air.
Checking the valve springs
1. Measure the valve spring free length a.
Replace if out of specification. 7
8
NOTE:
Do not mix the valve train parts. Keep them
9
Valve spring free length a:
organized in their proper groups.
44.20 mm (1.7402 in)

63P3F11 5-28
POWR
Power unit
2. Measure the valve spring tilt b. Replace
if out of specification. Valve stem diameter b:
Intake:
5.477–5.492 mm
(0.2156–0.2162 in)
Exhaust:
5.464–5.479 mm
(0.2151–0.2157 in)

4. Measure the valve stem runout. Replace


if out of specification.

Valve spring tilt limit b:


1.5 mm (0.06 in)

Checking the valves


1. Check the valve face for pitting or wear.
Replace if necessary.

2. Measure the valve margin thickness a.


Replace if out of specification.
Valve stem runout:
0.01 mm (0.0004 in)

Checking the valve guides


NOTE:
Before checking the valve guide make sure
that the valve stem diameter is within specifi-
cation.

1. Measure the valve guide inside diameter


Valve margin thickness a: a.
Intake: 0.70 mm (0.0276 in)
Exhaust: 1.00 mm (0.0394 in)

3. Measure the valve stem diameter b.


Replace if out of specification.

S69J5770

Valve guide inside diameter a:


5.504–5.522 mm
(0.2167–0.2174 in)

5-29 63P3F11
Cylinder head
2. Calculate the valve stem-to-valve guide
clearance as follows. Replace the valve Valve guide remover/installer:
guide if out of specification. 90890-06801
Valve guide installer: 90890-06810
Valve stem-to-valve guide clearance
= valve guide inside diameter – valve
stem diameter:
3. Insert the special service tool into the
valve guide 2, and then ream the valve
1
Intake and exhaust: guide.

2
0.025–0.058 mm
(0.0010–0.0023 in)

Replacing the valve guides


1. Remove the valve guide 1 by striking
the special service tool from the combus-
tion chamber side.
3
NOTE:
• Turn the valve guide reamer clockwise to
ream the valve guide.
4
• Do not turn the reamer counterclockwise
1 when removing the reamer.

Valve guide remover/installer:


S69J5790

Valve guide reamer: 90890-06804


5
90890-06801

2. Install a new valve guide 2 by striking


the special service tool from the cam-
shaft side until the valve guide installer
4. Measure the valve guide inside diameter.

Valve guide inside diameter:


6
5.504–5.522 mm
3 contacts the cylinder head. (0.2167–0.2174 in)

3
7
2

E
8
S69J5800

NOTE:
Apply engine oil to the surface of the new
valve guide.
9
63P3F11 5-30
POWR
Power unit
Checking the valve seat
1. Eliminate carbon deposits from the valve
with a scraper.

2. Apply a thin, even layer of Mechanic’s


blueing dye (Dykem) onto the valve seat.

3. Lap the valve slowly on the valve seat


with a valve lapper (commercially avail-
able) as shown.

Valve seat contact width a:


Intake:
1.1–1.4 mm (0.043–0.055 in)
Exhaust:
1.4–1.7 mm (0.055–0.067 in)

4. Measure the valve seat contact width a


Refacing the valve seat
where the blueing dye is adhered to the
1. Reface the valve seat with the valve seat
valve face. Reface the valve seat if the
cutter.
valve is not seated properly or if the valve
seat contact width is out of specification.
Replace the valve guide if the valve seat
contact is uneven.

Valve seat cutter holder:


90890-06316
Valve seat cutter:
30° (intake): 90890-06327
30° (exhaust): 90890-06326
45° (intake and exhaust):
90890-06325
60° (intake and exhaust):
90890-06324

2. Cut the surface of the valve seat with a


45° cutter by turning the cutter clockwise
until the valve seat face has become
smooth.

5-31 63P3F11
Cylinder head

1
60˚

S63P5240

b Previous contact width


S69J5890

5. Use a 45° cutter to adjust the contact


2
width of the valve seat to specification.

c
b
3
a Slag or rough surface

CAUTION: 45˚
4
S69J5900
Do not over cut the valve seat. Be sure to
turn the cutter evenly downward at a pres-
sure of 40–50 N (4–5 kgf, 8.8–11 lbf) to
prevent chatter marks.
b Previous contact width
c Specified contact width

6. If the valve seat contact area is too wide


5
and situated in the center of the valve
3. Use a 30° cutter to adjust the contact
width of the top edge of the valve seat.
face, use a 30° cutter to cut the top edge
of the valve seat, a 60° cutter to cut the
bottom edge to center the area and set
its width.
6
b

7
b Previous contact width
30˚
S69J5880
8
4. Use a 60° cutter to adjust the contact b Previous contact width
width of the bottom edge of the valve
seat. 9
63P3F11 5-32
POWR
Power unit
7. If the valve seat contact area is too nar-
row and situated near the top edge of the CAUTION:
valve face, use a 30° cutter to cut the top Do not get the lapping compound on the
edge of the valve seat. If necessary, use valve stem and valve guide.
a 45° cutter to center the area and set its
width.
10. After every lapping procedure, be sure to
clean off any remaining lapping com-
pound from the cylinder head and the
valve.

11. Check the valve seat contact area of the


valve again.

Checking the camshaft


1. Measure the cam lobe. Replace if out of
b Previous contact width specification.

8. If the valve seat contact area is too nar-


row and situated near the bottom edge of
the valve face, use a 60° cutter to cut the
bottom edge of the valve seat. If neces-
sary, use a 45° cutter to center the area
and set its width.

Cam lobe a:
Intake:
45.300–45.400 mm
(1.7835–1.7874 in)
Exhaust:
44.350–44.450 mm
b Previous contact width (1.7461–1.7500 in)
Cam lobe b:
9. Apply a thin, even layer of lapping com- Intake and exhaust:
pound onto the valve seat, and then lap 35.950–36.050 mm
the valve using a valve lapper (commer- (1.4154–1.4193 in)
cially available).
2. Measure the camshaft runout. Replace if
out of specification.

5-33 63P3F11
Cylinder head
Checking the cylinder head
1. Eliminate carbon deposits from the com-
bustion chambers and check for deterio-

1
ration.

2. Check the cylinder head warpage using a


straightedge 1 and thickness gauge 2
in seven directions as shown. Replace if

2
out of specification.

2
1

3
S63P5180

Camshaft runout limit:


0.03 mm (0.0012 in)

4
3. Measure the camshaft journal diameter S63P5190

c and cylinder head journal inside diam-


eter d. Replace the camshaft and cylin-
der head if out of specification.

c
5
6
S63P5200
d
Cylinder head warpage limit:
S69J5970 0.10 mm (0.0039 in)

Camshaft journal diameter c:


24.960–24.980 mm
(0.9827–0.9835 in)
Camshaft cap inside diameter d:
Installing the valves
1. Install a new valve seal 1 into the valve
guide.
7
25.000–25.021 mm
(0.9843–0.9851 in)

4. Calculate the camshaft oil clearance e


as follows. Replace the camshaft and
8
cylinder head as a set if out of specifica-
tion.

Camshaft oil clearance e =


Camshaft cap inside diameter d –
9
Camshaft journal diameter c:
0.020–0.060 mm
(0.0008–0.0024 in)

63P3F11 5-34
POWR
Power unit
2. Install the valve 2, valve spring 3, and
valve spring retainer 4 in the sequence
shown, and then attach the special ser-
vice tool.

S63P5210

NOTE:
Apply engine oil to the valve shims and valve
lifters before installation.

Installing the cylinder head


1. Install a new gasket and the cylinder
head, and then tighten the bolts to the
NOTE: specified torques in the sequence
The valve spring can be installed in any shown.
direction.
9 0
G E
Valve spring compressor 5: E
5 6
90890-04019 C
1 2
Valve spring compressor
A
attachment 6: B4 3
90890-06320 D
F 7
8
3. Compress the valve spring, and then
J I H
install the valve cotter 7 using a thin a 90˚
screwdriver with a small amount of
grease applied to it.
S63P5220

CAUTION:
Do not reuse the cylinder head gasket,
always replace it with a new one.

4. Lightly tap the valve spring retainer with


a plastic hammer to set the valve cotter
securely.

5-35 63P3F11
Cylinder head
3. Install the camshaft caps, and then
NOTE: tighten the bolts to the specified torques
• Apply engine oil to the cylinder head bolts in two stages and in the sequence
before installation.

1
shown.
• Tighten the M10 bolts to the specified
torques in two stages first, and then make a
2
mark a on the M10 bolts and the cylinder
head, and then tighten the bolts 90° from
E E
the mark.
• Tighten the M8 bolts to the specified
torques in two stages.
5
1
6
7
5
1
1
2
2
Cylinder head bolt (M10): 48 43
1st: 19 N·m (1.9 kgf·m, 14.0 ft·lb)
3
T.

2 2
R.

9 4
2nd: 37 N·m (3.7 kgf·m, 27.3 ft·lb)
3rd: 90° 310 35
Cylinder head bolt (M8): S63P5120
1st: 14 N·m (1.4 kgf·m, 10.3 ft·lb)
2nd: 28 N·m (2.8 kgf·m, 20.7 ft·lb)

2. Install the camshafts into the cylinder


NOTE:
• Install the camshaft caps in the proper posi-
tion as shown and with the stamped num-
4
head with new oil seals. bers facing upside down.

5
• Apply engine oil to the camshaft cap bolts
before installation.
E

E 63P IN Camshaft cap bolt:


1st: 8 N·m (0.8 kgf·m, 5.9 ft·lb)
T.

6
R.

63P EX
2nd: 17 N·m (1.7 kgf·m, 12.5 ft·lb)
M

S63P5110

7
8
S63P5C70

NOTE:
Install the camshafts so that the dowels are
facing inward and that they are aligned with
the mating surface of the cylinder head.
9
63P3F11 5-36
POWR
Power unit
Removing the exhaust cover Installing the pressure control valve
1. Remove the cover 1 and thermostat 2. 1. Install a new gasket and the pressure
control valve, and then tighten the bolts.
2
1

LT
S63P3110 572
S63P5670

2. Remove the exhaust cover bolts in the


sequence shown.

Checking the pressure control valve


1. Remove the pressure control valve.

2. Check the pressure control valve 1 for


wear or damage. Replace if necessary.

3. Check the grommet 2 for deformation.


Replace if necessary.

4. Check the spring 3 for fatigue or defor-


mation. Replace if necessary.

3
S60V5610

5-37 63P3F11
Cylinder head / Cylinder block
Cylinder block 5

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Engine hanger 1
2
3
4
5
Bolt
Oil filler cap
O-ring
Oil filler neck
3
1
1
1
M6 × 20 mm

7
6 Gasket 1 Not reusable
7
8
9
10
Bolt
Seal
Balancer assembly
Bolt
2
2
1
10
M6 × 45 mm
Not reusable

M8 × 55 mm
8
11 Bolt 2 M6 × 40 mm
12
13
14
15
O-ring
Plug
Oil pump assembly
Oil seal
1
1
1
1
Not reusable

Not reusable
9
16 O-ring 2 Not reusable
17 Gasket 1 Not reusable

63P3F11 5-38
POWR
Power unit
5

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Oil seal 1 Not reusable
19 Oil seal 2 Not reusable
20 Bolt 4 M6 × 40 mm

5-39 63P3F11
Cylinder block
5

1 30 N · m (3.0 kgf · m, 22.1 ft · Ib)


30 N · m (3.0 kgf · m, 22.1 ft · Ib)

1
1

T.
2 90˚

R.
T.

2 90˚
R.

6
3
4 5
1
1
S1280B

2
E

2
E

7
E
3
E

E
8
9
E 11

13
1516
17
4
9

1 14 N · m (1.4 kgf · m, 10.3 ft · lb)


9
9

14
E
12
UP
63
P

5
26 N · m (2.6 kgf · m, 19.2 ft · Ib) 1 23 N · m (2.3 kgf · m, 17.0 ft · Ib)
T.

2
R.

43 N · m (4.3 kgf · m, 31.7 ft · Ib)

6
2
T.
R.

E 10 3 90˚
S63P5650

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Bolt 10 M10 × 85 mm
2
3
4
5
Bolt
Crankcase
Main bearing cap
Collar
10
1
1
10
M8 × 55 mm

7
6 Cylinder block 1
7
8
9
10
Oil seal
Crankshaft
Main bearing
Oil seal
1
1
10
1
Not reusable

Not reusable
8
11 Connecting rod bearing 8
12
13
14
15
Piston/connecting rod assembly
Connecting rod cap
Bolt
Oil ring
4
4
8
4
Not reusable
9
16 2nd piston ring 4
17 Top ring 4

63P3F11 5-40
POWR
Power unit
Disassembling the cylinder block
NOTE:
1. Remove the oil pump.
• Be sure to keep the bearings in the order as
2. Remove the balancer bolts in the they were removed.
sequence shown. • Mark each piston with an identification
number a of the corresponding cylinder.
• Do not mix the connecting rods and caps.
Keep them organized in their proper
groups.

5. Remove the main bearing cap bolts in


the sequence shown.

3. Remove the crankcase bolts in the


sequence shown.

6. Remove the crankshaft.

Checking the balancer assembly


1. Check the teeth of the balancer shaft
gear for cracks or wear. Replace the bal-
NOTE: ancer assembly if necessary.
Do not remove the plugs 1 from the crank-
case.

4. Remove the connecting rod bolts and the


connecting rod caps, and then remove
the connecting rod and piston assem-
blies.

Checking the piston diameter


1. Measure the piston outside diameter at
the specified measuring point. Replace if
out of specification.

5-41 63P3F11
Cylinder block
3. Calculate the out-of-round limit. Replace
the cylinder block if out of specification.

Out-of-round limit:
D2–D1 (measuring point a)
D6–D5 (measuring point c)
0.05 mm (0.0020 in)
1
Piston diameter a:
Checking the piston clearance
1. Replace the piston and piston rings as a
set, or the cylinder block, or all parts if
out of specification.
2
93.928–93.934 mm
(3.6979–3.6982 in)
Measuring point b:
5.0 mm (0.20 in) up from the
bottom of the piston skirt
Piston clearance:
0.075–0.080 mm
(0.0030–0.0031 in) 3
Checking the piston rings
Checking the cylinder bore
1. Measure the cylinder bore (D1–D6) at
measuring points a, b, and c, and in
direction d (D1, D3, D5), which is parallel
1. Check the piston ring dimensions of B
and T. Replace if out of specification. 4
to the crankshaft, and direction e (D2,
D4, D6), which is at a right angle to the
crankshaft.
5
a
c
b D2

D4
D1

D3
d

e
Piston ring dimensions:
6
D6 D5
Top ring a:

a 20 mm (0.8 in)
b 60 mm (2.4 in)
S69J5B70
B: 1.17–1.19 mm
(0.0461–0.0469 in)
T: 2.80–3.00 mm
(0.1102–0.1181 in)
7
c 100 mm (3.9 in)
Second ring b:
Cylinder bore (D1–D6):
94.000–94.017 mm
(3.7008–3.7014 in)
B: 1.17–1.19 mm
(0.0461–0.0469 in)
T: 3.70–3.90 mm
8
(0.1457–0.1535 in)
Oil ring c:
2. Calculate the taper limit. Replace the cyl-
inder block if out of specification.

Taper limit:
B: 2.40–2.47 mm
(0.0945–0.0972 in)
T: 2.30–2.70 mm
9
D1–D5 (direction d) (0.0906–0.1063 in)
D2–D6 (direction e)
0.08 mm (0.0032 in)

63P3F11 5-42
POWR
Power unit
2. Level the piston ring 1 in the cylinder
with a piston crown. Piston ring groove:
Top ring a:
3. Check the piston ring end gap d at the 1.23–1.25 mm (0.048–0.049 in)
specified measuring point. Replace if out Second ring b:
of specification. 1.22–1.24 mm (0.048–0.049 in)
Oil ring c:
2.51–2.53 mm (0.099–0.100 in)

Checking the piston ring side


clearance
1. Measure the piston ring side clearance.
Replace the piston and piston rings as a
set if out of specification.

Piston ring end gap d: c


Top ring:
0.15–0.30 mm S63P5730
(0.0059–0.0118 in)
Second ring: Piston ring side clearance:
0.30–0.45 mm Top ring a:
(0.0118–0.0177 in) 0.04–0.08 mm
Oil ring: (0.0016–0.0031 in)
0.15–0.60 mm Second ring b:
(0.0059–0.0236 in) 0.03–0.07 mm
Measuring point e: 20 mm (0.8 in) (0.0012–0.0028 in)
Oil ring c:
Checking the piston ring grooves 0.04–0.13 mm
1. Measure the piston ring grooves. (0.0016–0.0051 in)
Replace the piston if out of specification.
Checking the connecting rod big end
a side clearance
1. Measure the connecting rod big end side
clearance a. Replace the connecting
b rod or crankshaft, or both if out of specifi-
cation.
c

S63P5720

5-43 63P3F11
Cylinder block

1
Crankshaft journal diameter a:
2
51.980–52.000 mm
(2.0465–2.0472 in)

Connecting rod big end side


clearance a:
Crankpin diameter b:
49.980–50.000 mm
(1.9677–1.9685 in)
3
0.14–0.31 mm (0.006–0.012 in) Crankpin width c:

4
22.00–22.10 mm
Checking the crankshaft (0.8661–0.8701 in)
1. Check the teeth of the crankshaft gear
for cracks or wear. Replace the crank- 3. Measure the crankshaft runout. Replace
shaft if necessary. the crankshaft if out of specification.

5
6
2. Measure the crankshaft journal diameter
a, crankpin diameter b, and crankpin
width c. Replace the crankshaft if out of S63P5550
7
specification.
Crankshaft runout limit:
0.03 mm (0.0012 in)
8
9
63P3F11 5-44
POWR
Power unit
Checking the crankpin oil clearance
1. Clean the bearings and the connecting
rod.

2. Install the upper bearing into the con-


necting rod 1 and the lower bearing into
the connecting rod cap 2.

NOTE:
Install the connecting rod bearings in their NOTE:
original positions. Make sure that the mark a of the connecting
rod faces towards the flywheel magnet side
of the crankshaft.
3. Put a piece of Plastigauge (PG-1) onto
the crankpin, parallel to the crankshaft.
5. Tighten the connecting rod bolts to the
specified torques in three stages.

NOTE:
Be sure not to put the Plastigauge (PG-1)
over the oil hole in the crankpin of the crank- NOTE:
shaft. • Reuse the removed connecting rod bolts
when checking the oil clearance.
• Do not turn the connecting rod until the
4. Install the connecting rod to the crankpin
crankpin oil clearance measurement has
3.
been completed.
• Make a mark b on the connecting rod
bolts, connecting rod caps, and then tighten
the bolts 90° from the mark.

5-45 63P3F11
Cylinder block
Example:
Connecting rod bolt:
1st: 23 N·m (2.3 kgf·m, 17.0 ft·lb) Connecting rod big Numerical value
T.
R.

2nd: 43 N·m (4.3 kgf·m, 31.7 ft·lb) end inside diameter a in table
3rd: 90°

6. Remove the connecting rod cap and


53.035 mm

3. Check the crankpin mark b on the


crankshaft.
35
1
measure the width of the compressed

2
Plastigauge (PG-1) on each crankpin.
P1 P4
Replace the connecting rod bearing if out
of specification.

P2 P3

3
b

P1 P2 P3 P4 S63P5530
4
Crankpin oil clearance:
0.027–0.052 mm
(0.0011–0.0020 in)

Selecting the connecting rod bearing


5
1. When replacing the connecting rod bear-
ing, select the suitable bearing as fol-
lows.

2. Measure the connecting rod big end


6
inside diameter a.

7
a
8
S60C5980

NOTE:
Reuse the connecting rod bolts. 9
63P3F11 5-46
POWR
Power unit
4. Select the suitable color c for the con-
necting rod bearing from the table. NOTE:
• Example: If the connecting rod big end
c inside diameter a is “35” and the crankpin
mark b is “81,” then select the bearing col-
ors in “g.”
• If the connecting rod inside diameter can-
not be measured, measure the crankpin oil
clearance using Plastigauge (PG-1) and
select the suitable combination of upper
and lower bearings from the table above so
c S63P5800 that the oil clearance is within specification.

Connecting rod big end inside


diameter a Checking the crankshaft main
80
25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45
journal oil clearance
1. Clean the bearings, main journals, and
81
82
h
83
bearing portions of the crankcase and
84
g cylinder block.
85
Crankpin mark b

86
87
2. Place the cylinder block upside down on
88
a bench.
89
90
f
91
92 3. Install half of the bearings 1 and the
crankshaft 2 into the cylinder block 3.
93
94
95
e
96
97
98
99
d
00

Upper bearing Lower bearing


color color
d Green Green
e Green Blue
f Blue Blue
g Blue Red NOTE:
Install the main bearings in their original posi-
h Red Red
tions.

4. Put a piece of Plastigauge (PG-1) on


each main journal parallel to the crank-
shaft.

5-47 63P3F11
Cylinder block
Selecting the crankshaft main
bearing
1. When replacing the main bearing, select
the suitable bearing as follows.

2. Check the crankshaft journal mark a on


the crankshaft and the cylinder block
1
mark b on the cylinder block.

NOTE:
Do not put the Plastigauge (PG-1) over the
J1 J2 J3 J4 J5
2
oil hole in the main journals of the crankshaft.

5. Install the remaining half of the bearings


into the main bearing cap and crankcase.
3
J2 J3 J4
J1 J5

4
NOTE:
Install the main bearings in their original posi- a
tions.
S63P5540

6. Install the main bearing cap and crank-


case onto the cylinder block and apply
engine oil to the threads of the bolts. 5
7. Remove the main bearing cap and crank-
case, and then measure the width of the
compressed Plastigauge (PG-1) on each
main journal. Replace the main bearing if
out of specification.
6
7
8
Crankshaft main journal oil
clearance:
0.021–0.050 mm
(0.0008–0.0020 in)
9
63P3F11 5-48
POWR
Power unit
3. Select the suitable color c for the main
bearing from the table.

c S63P5850

Cylinder block mark b


20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38
80
81
82
Checking the oil pump
i
Crankshaft journal mark a

83 1. Check the gear teeth for cracks or wear


84
85
and the oil pump case for scratches.
86 h Replace the oil pump assembly if neces-
87
88 sary.
89 g
90
91 Assembling the oil pump
92 f
93 1. Install a new oil seal into the oil pump
94
95 e housing.
96
97
98 d
99
00

Upper bearing Lower bearing


color color
d Green Green
e Green Red
f Red Red
g Red Yellow Needle bearing attachment 1:
h Yellow Yellow 90890-06654
i Yellow Blue + green Driver rod L3 2: 90890-06652

NOTE: 2. Apply grease to new oil seals, and then


• Example: If the crankshaft journal mark a install them into the oil pump housing.
is “89” and the cylinder block mark b is
“28,” then select the bearing colors in “g.”
• Main bearing #3 is a thrust bearing.

Disassembling the oil pump


1. Remove the screws 1 and disassemble
the oil pump.

5-49 63P3F11
Cylinder block

Screw 8:
4 N·m (0.4 kgf·m, 3.0 ft·lb)

T.
R.
Assembling the pistons and cylinder
block
1. Install the oil ring 1, second ring 2, and
1
top ring 3 onto the pistons with the “RN”

Needle bearing attachment 3:


mark a of the second ring and the “R”
mark a of the top ring facing upward.

2. Offset the piston ring end gaps as


2
90890-06611
shown.
Driver rod L3 4: 90890-06652

3. Install a new oil seal into the oil pump


housing.
a
#3
45˚

UP
63P
45˚
#2 3
RN
UP

4
63P

#5 #1,#4 #5
#4
#3 2
#2 3
#1

E
R
a

S63P5930
5
General pipe 5:
a = 45 mm (1.77 in)

4. Install a new oil seal 6 and the gasket


CAUTION:
Do not scratch the pistons or break the
piston rings.
6
7, and then tighten the screws 8 to the
specified torque. NOTE:
After installing the piston rings, check that
they move smoothly. 7
8
9
63P3F11 5-50
POWR
Power unit
3. Install the upper bearing into the con-
necting rod 4 and the lower bearing into
the connecting rod cap 5.

NOTE:
Install the connecting rod bearings in their NOTE:
original positions. Apply engine oil to the inner oil seal before
installation.

4. Install half of the main bearings 6 and


the thrust bearing 7 into the cylinder 6. Install half of the main bearings A into
block 8. the main bearing cap B.

NOTE: NOTE:
Install the main bearings in their original posi- Install the main bearings in their original posi-
tions. tions.

5. Set the crankshaft 9 and oil seal 0 into 7. Tighten the main bearing cap bolts to the
the cylinder block as shown. specified torques in two stages and in the
sequence shown.

5-51 63P3F11
Cylinder block

NOTE:
Apply engine oil to the side of the pistons and
piston rings before installation.

Piston ring compressor:


90890-05158
1
9. Install the connecting rod caps 5 to the
connecting rods, and then tighten the
connecting rod bolts to the specified
torques in three stages.
2
c
3
NOTE:
• Main bearing cap bolts 1–6 can be
reused three times.
E
5
4
• Apply engine oil to the main bearing cap
d

5
bolts before installation. 90˚
• Make a mark b on the main bearing caps
and main bearing cap bolts, and then
S63P5A20
tighten the main bearing cap bolts 90° from
the mark.
CAUTION:

Main bearing cap bolt:


1st: 30 N·m (3.0 kgf·m, 22.1 ft·lb)
Do not reuse the connecting rod bolts,
always replace them with new ones. 6
T.
R.

2nd: 90°
NOTE:
8. Install the piston with the “UP” mark on
the piston crown facing towards the fly-
wheel magnet.
• Make sure that the mark c of the connect-
ing rod faces towards the flywheel magnet
side of the crankshaft.
• Apply engine oil to the connecting rod bolts
7
before installation.
• Make a mark d on the connecting rod bolts
and connecting rod caps, and then tighten
the bolts 90° from the mark.
8
Connecting rod bolt:
1st: 23 N·m (2.3 kgf·m, 17.0 ft·lb)
9
T.
R.

2nd: 43 N·m (4.3 kgf·m, 31.7 ft·lb)


3rd: 90°

63P3F11 5-52
POWR
Power unit
10. Install half of the main bearings A into
the crankcase. NOTE:
• Crankcase bolts 1–4 can be reused three
11. Apply sealant to the mating surface of times.
the crankcase. • Apply engine oil to the crankcase bolts
before installation.
• Tighten crankcase bolts 1–4 to the speci-
fied torques in two stages first, and then
tighten crankcase bolts 5–D to the speci-
fied torques in two stages.
• Make a mark e on the crankcase and
crankcase bolts, and then tighten crank-
case bolts 1–4 90° from the mark.

1–4 Crankcase bolt (M10):


1st: 30 N·m (3.0 kgf·m, 22.1 ft·lb)

T.
NOTE:

R.
• Install the main bearings in their original 2nd: 90°
positions. 5–D Crankcase bolt (M8):
• Do not get any sealant on the main bear- 1st: 14 N·m (1.4 kgf·m, 10.3 ft·lb)
ings. 2nd: 26 N·m (2.6 kgf·m, 19.2 ft·lb)

14. Align the keyway f in the crankshaft


12. Install the crankcase onto the cylinder
with the cylinder block and crankcase
block.
mating surfaces.
13. Tighten the crankcase bolts to the speci-
fied torques in two stages and in the
sequence shown.

15. Align the marks g on the balancer shafts


with the alignment marks h.

5-53 63P3F11
Cylinder block
16. Apply sealant to the mating surface of 18. After installing the balancer assembly
the balancer assembly. onto the crankcase, apply sealant around
the periphery of the seals C, and then

1
install them onto the balancer assembly.

2
NOTE:
Do not get any sealant inside the balancer
assembly. 19. Align the oil pump gear with the crank-
shaft, and then install the oil pump D.
3
17. Install the balancer assembly onto the
crankcase, and then tighten the balancer
assembly bolts to the specified torques in
two stages and in the sequence shown. i
4
i
D
S63P5A90
5
6
1–0 Balancer bolt (M8):
1st: 18 N·m (1.8 kgf·m, 13.3 ft·lb)
7
T.
R.

2nd: 31 N·m (3.1 kgf·m, 22.9 ft·lb)


A, B Balancer bolt (M6):
1st: 7 N·m (0.7 kgf·m, 5.2 ft·lb)
2nd: 13 N·m (1.3 kgf·m, 9.6 ft·lb) NOTE:
• Before installing the oil pump, be sure to fill
it with a small amount of engine oil through
the oil passage i.
• When installing the oil pump, install it so
8
that the oil seal does not get damaged.

9
63P3F11 5-54
POWR
Power unit
20. Before installing the oil filter, be sure to
fill it with engine oil through the oil pas-
sage j of the oil filter bracket.

S63P5B20

21. Install the oil filter, and then tighten it to


the specified torque using a 72.5 mm Exhaust cover bolt:
(2.9 in) oil filter wrench. 1st: 6 N·m (0.6 kgf·m, 4.4 ft·lb)

T.
R.
2nd: 12 N·m (1.2 kgf·m, 8.9 ft·lb)

23. Install the thermostat E and cover F.

E
F

NOTE:
Apply a thin coat of engine oil to the O-ring of
S63P5C50
the new oil filter before installation.
Thermostat cover bolt:
1st: 6 N·m (0.6 kgf·m, 4.4 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Oil filter wrench: 90890-06830 2nd: 12 N·m (1.2 kgf·m, 8.9 ft·lb)

Installing the power unit


Oil filter:
1. Clean the power unit mating surface, and
18 N·m (1.8 kgf·m, 13.3 ft·lb)
T.
R.

install the dowels 1 and a new gasket


2.
22. Install a new gasket and the exhaust
cover, and then tighten the bolts to the 2. Install the power unit 3 by installing the
specified torques in two stages and in the bolts 4 and bolts 5, then tightening
sequence shown. them to the specified torque.

3. Install the apron 6, then tighten them to


the specified torque.

5-55 63P3F11
Cylinder block
6. Connect the fuel hose 8.

2
1
1 1

4
LT
572
8
S63P5B80 2
7. Connect the PTT motor leads 9, and
LT 4 5
LT
then install the junction box cover.

3
572 S63P5B40
572

6
9
4
5
S63P5B50 S63P5B90

Power unit mounting bolt (M8) 4: PTT motor lead bolt:


4 N·m (0.4 kgf·m, 3.0 ft·lb)
T.
R.

20 N·m (2.0 kgf·m, 14.8 ft·lb)


T.
R.

Power unit mounting bolt (M10) 5:


8. Connect the shift cable 0 and throttle

6
42 N·m (4.2 kgf·m, 31.0 ft·lb)
Apron bolt: cable A, and then adjust their lengths.
8 N·m (0.8 kgf·m, 5.9 ft·lb) For adjustment procedures, see Chapter
Apron screw: 3, “Adjusting the throttle link and throttle
4 N·m (0.4 kgf·m, 3.0 ft·lb) cable” and “Checking the gear shift oper-

4. Connect the PTT switch coupler, shift cut


switch coupler, neutral switch coupler,
cooling water pilot hose, and flushing
ation.”

0 A
7
hose.

5. Install the dipstick guide 7.


8
9
S63P5B60

7
S63P5C80

63P3F11 5-56
POWR
Power unit
9. Connect the battery leads B.
Flywheel holder: 90890-06522

Flywheel magnet nut:


270 N·m (27.0 kgf·m, 199.1 ft·lb)

T.
R.
13. Install all parts removed during disas-
B
sembly.
S63P5C10

Positive battery cable nut:


9 N·m (0.9 kgf·m, 6.6 ft·lb)
T.
R.

10. Install the stator coil assembly.

11. Install the Woodruff key.

12. Install the flywheel magnet.

CAUTION:
Apply force in the direction of the arrows
shown to prevent the flywheel holder from
slipping off easily.

NOTE:
Apply engine oil to the flywheel magnet nut
before installation.

5-57 63P3F11
Cylinder block

— MEMO —

1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11 5-58
LOWR

Lower unit

Special service tools .....................................................................................6-1

Lower unit (regular rotation model) ............................................................. 6-4


Removing the lower unit ............................................................................6-8
Removing the water pump and shift rod.................................................... 6-8
Checking the water pump and shift rod .....................................................6-9

Propeller shaft housing (regular rotation model) ..................................... 6-10


Removing the propeller shaft housing assembly..................................... 6-12
Disassembling the propeller shaft assembly ...........................................6-12
Disassembling the propeller shaft housing.............................................. 6-12
Checking the propeller shaft housing ......................................................6-13
Checking the propeller shaft.................................................................... 6-13
Assembling the propeller shaft assembly ................................................ 6-14
Assembling the propeller shaft housing...................................................6-14

Drive shaft and lower case (regular rotation model) ................................6-16


Removing the drive shaft.........................................................................6-17
Disassembling the drive shaft housing ....................................................6-17
Disassembling the forward gear ..............................................................6-17
Disassembling the lower case .................................................................6-17
Checking the pinion and forward gear.....................................................6-18
Checking the bearings............................................................................. 6-18
Checking the drive shaft ..........................................................................6-18
Checking the lower case .........................................................................6-18
Assembling the lower case...................................................................... 6-19
Assembling the forward gear................................................................... 6-19
Assembling the drive shaft housing......................................................... 6-19
Installing the drive shaft...........................................................................6-20
Installing the propeller shaft housing .......................................................6-21
Installing the water pump and shift rod....................................................6-21
Installing the lower unit ............................................................................6-23

Shimming (regular rotation model) ............................................................ 6-25


Shimming.................................................................................................6-26
Selecting the pinion shims....................................................................... 6-26
Selecting the forward gear shims ............................................................ 6-27
Selecting the reverse gear shims ............................................................ 6-28

Backlash (regular rotation model)..............................................................6-29


Measuring the forward and reverse gear backlash .................................6-29

63P3F11
Lower unit (counter rotation model) .......................................................... 6-32
Removing the lower unit ..........................................................................6-36
Removing the water pump and shift rod.................................................. 6-36
Checking the water pump and shift rod ...................................................6-37

Propeller shaft housing (counter rotation model) .................................... 6-38


Removing the propeller shaft housing assembly..................................... 6-40
1
Disassembling the propeller shaft assembly ...........................................6-40
Disassembling the forward gear ..............................................................6-40
Disassembling the propeller shaft housing.............................................. 6-41
Checking the propeller shaft housing ......................................................6-41
Checking the propeller shaft.................................................................... 6-41
Assembling the propeller shaft housing...................................................6-41
2
Drive shaft and lower case (counter rotation model) ...............................6-44
Removing the drive shaft.........................................................................6-46
Disassembling the drive shaft housing ....................................................6-46
3
Disassembling the reverse gear ..............................................................6-46
Disassembling the lower case .................................................................6-46
Checking the pinion and reverse gear.....................................................6-47
Checking the bearings............................................................................. 6-47
Checking the drive shaft ..........................................................................6-47
Checking the lower case .........................................................................6-47
4
Assembling the lower case...................................................................... 6-47
Assembling the reverse gear................................................................... 6-48
Assembling the drive shaft housing......................................................... 6-48
Installing the drive shaft...........................................................................6-49
Installing the propeller shaft housing .......................................................6-49
5
Installing the water pump and shift rod....................................................6-50
Installing the lower unit ............................................................................6-52

Shimming (counter rotation model) ........................................................... 6-54


Shimming.................................................................................................6-55
6
Selecting the pinion shims....................................................................... 6-55
Selecting the reverse gear shims ............................................................ 6-56
Selecting the forward gear shims ............................................................ 6-57
Selecting the propeller shaft shims.......................................................... 6-58
7
Backlash (counter rotation model)............................................................. 6-60
Measuring the forward and reverse gear backlash .................................6-60
8
9
63P3F11
LOWR
Lower unit
Special service tools 6

Ring nut wrench 4 Bearing separator


90890-06512 90890-06534

Ring nut wrench extension Stopper guide stand


90890-06513 90890-06538

Bearing housing puller claw L Bearing puller assembly


90890-06502 90890-06535

Stopper guide plate Needle bearing attachment


90890-06501 90890-06610, 90890-06612, 90890-06653,
90890-06654

Center bolt
90890-06504 Driver rod L3
90890-06652

6-1 63P3F11
Special service tools

1
Driver rod SS Bearing outer race puller assembly
90890-06604 90890-06523

2
Bearing depth plate Ball bearing attachment
3
90890-06603 90890-06633, 90890-06636, 90890-06629

4
Bearing inner race attachment Bearing outer race attachment
5
90890-06640, 90890-06660 90890-06619

6
Drive shaft holder 6
90890-06520
Driver rod LL
90890-06605
7
8
Pinion nut holder
New: 90890-06715
Current: 90890-06505
Driver rod LS
90890-06606
9
63P3F11 6-2
LOWR
Lower unit

Shift rod push arm Magnet base plate


90890-06052 90890-07003

Pinion height gauge Dial gauge set


90890-06710 90890-01252

Digital caliper Magnet base B


90890-06704 90890-06844

Shimming plate Ring nut wrench


90890-06701 90890-06578

Backlash indicator Outer race puller claw B


90890-06706 90890-06533

6-3 63P3F11
Special service tools / Lower unit (regular rotation model)
Lower unit (regular rotation model) 6

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Lower unit 1
2
3
4
5
Check screw
Gasket
Bolt
Drain screw
1
2
6
1
Not reusable
M10 × 45 mm 7
6 Grommet 1
7
8
9
10
Bolt
Bolt
Spacer
Propeller
1
1
1
1
M10 × 44 mm
M10 × 70 mm / L-transom model
8
11 Washer 1
12
13
14
15
Washer
Cotter pin
Propeller nut
Trim tab
1
1
1
1
Not reusable
9
16 Dowel 2 X-transom model
17 Water pipe 1 X-transom model

63P3F11 6-4
LOWR
Lower unit
6

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Extension 1 X-transom model
19 Bolt 6 M10 × 45 mm / X-transom model
20 Bolt 1 M10 × 200 mm / X-transom model

6-5 63P3F11
Lower unit (regular rotation model)
6

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Shift rod 1
2
3
4
5
Oil seal
Oil seal housing
O-ring
Spring
1
1
1
1
Not reusable

Not reusable 7
6 Circlip 1
7
8
9
10
Bolt
Hose nipple
O-ring
Woodruff key
3
1
1
1
M6 × 20 mm

Not reusable
8
11 Bolt 4 M8 × 45 mm
12
13
14
15
Cover
Seal
Water pump housing
O-ring
1
1
1
1 Not reusable
9
16 Insert cartridge 1
17 O-ring 1 Not reusable

63P3F11 6-6
LOWR
Lower unit
6

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Collar 1
19 Spacer 1
20 Washer 2
21 Wave washer 1
22 Impeller 1
23 Outer plate cartridge 1
24 Gasket 1 Not reusable
25 Dowel 2
26 Dowel 2

6-7 63P3F11
Lower unit (regular rotation model)
Removing the lower unit
1. Drain the gear oil. For draining proce-
dures, see Chapter 3, “Changing the

1
gear oil.”

2. Set the gear shift to the neutral position,


and place a block of wood between the
anti-cavitation plate and propeller to keep

2
the propeller from turning, and then
remove the propeller nut and propeller.

3
WARNING
È X-transom model

NOTE:
Check that there is no oil on the spline and
4
check it for wear.
• Do not hold the propeller with your
hands when loosening or tightening it.
• Be sure to disconnect the battery leads
from the battery and the engine stop lan-
yard from the engine stop lanyard
Removing the water pump and shift
rod
5
1. Remove the water pump assembly and
switch.
shift rod assembly 1.
• Put a block of wood between the anti-
cavitation plate and propeller to keep
the propeller from turning.
6
3. Mark the trim tab 1 at the area shown,
and then remove it.

4. Loosen the bolts, and then remove the


7
lower unit from the upper case.

8
9
63P3F11 6-8
LOWR
Lower unit
Checking the water pump and shift
rod
1. Check the water pump housing for defor-
mation. Replace if necessary.

S69J6045

S69J6030

2. Check the impeller 1 and insert car-


tridge 2 for cracks or wear. Replace if
necessary.

1 2

S63P6050

3. Check the Woodruff key 3 and the key-


way a in the drive shaft for wear.
Replace if necessary.

a
3

S69J6040

4. Check the shift rod for cracks or wear.


Replace if necessary.

6-9 63P3F11
Lower unit (regular rotation model) / Propeller shaft housing (regular rotation model)
Propeller shaft housing (regular rotation model) 6

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Shift rod joint 1
2
3
4
5
Ball
Shift slider
Ball
Ball
2
1
2
2
7
6 Spring 1
7
8
9
10
Dog clutch
Cross pin
Spring
Propeller shaft
1
1
1
1
8
11 Reverse gear shim —
12
13
14
15
Washer
Reverse gear
Thrust washer
Ball bearing
1
1
1
1 Not reusable
9
16 O-ring 1 Not reusable
17 Propeller shaft housing 1

63P3F11 6-10
LOWR
Lower unit
6

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Straight key 1
19 Needle bearing 1
20 Oil seal 2 Not reusable
21 Claw washer 1
22 Ring nut 1
23 Cooling water inlet cover 2
24 Nut 1
25 Screw 1

6-11 63P3F11
Propeller shaft housing (regular rotation model)
Removing the propeller shaft
housing assembly
1. Straighten the claw washer tabs a, and
then remove the ring nut and claw
washer.
1
Disassembling the propeller shaft
2
housing

3
1. Remove the reverse gear and thrust
washer.

Ring nut wrench 4 1: 90890-06512


Ring nut wrench extension 2:
90890-06513

2. Pull out the propeller shaft housing


assembly.
4
5
Bearing separator 1: 90890-06534
Stopper guide plate 2: 90890-06501
6
Stopper guide stand 3:
Bearing housing puller claw L 3:
90890-06502
Stopper guide plate 4: 90890-06501
Center bolt 5: 90890-06504
90890-06538
Bearing puller assembly 4:
90890-06535 7
Disassembling the propeller shaft
assembly
1. Remove the spring 1, then the cross pin
8
2, dog clutch 3, balls 4, spring 5, shift
slider 6, and shift rod joint 7.

9
63P3F11 6-12
LOWR
Lower unit
2. Remove the ball bearing. 2. Check the teeth and dogs of the reverse
gear for cracks or wear. Replace the
gear if necessary.

Stopper guide plate 5: 90890-06501 S62Y6640

Stopper guide stand 6:


90890-06538 3. Check the bearings for pitting or rum-
Bearing puller assembly 7: bling. Replace if necessary.
90890-06535

3. Remove the oil seals and needle bear-


ing.

S69J6115

Checking the propeller shaft


1. Check the propeller shaft for bends or
wear. Replace if necessary.

Needle bearing attachment 8:


90890-06653
Driver rod L3 9: 90890-06652

Checking the propeller shaft housing


1. Clean the propeller shaft housing using a
soft brush and cleaning solvent, and then
check it for cracks. Replace if necessary.

2. Check the dog clutch, shift rod joint and


shift slider for cracks or wear. Replace if
necessary.

6-13 63P3F11
Propeller shaft housing (regular rotation model)

NOTE:
• Install the needle bearing with the manufac-
ture identification mark a facing toward the
oil seal (propeller side).
• When using the driver rod, do not strike the
special service tool in a manner that will
force the stopper c out of place.
1
Assembling the propeller shaft
Driver rod SS 1: 90890-06604
Needle bearing attachment 2:
90890-06610
2
assembly
Bearing depth plate 3: 90890-06603

3
1. Install the dog clutch as shown.

Depth b:
24.75–25.25 mm (0.974–0.994 in)

2. Apply grease to new oil seals, and then


install them into the propeller shaft hous-
ing to the specified depth.
4
NOTE:
Install the dog clutch 1 with the “F” mark a
5
facing toward the shift slider.

Assembling the propeller shaft


housing
6
1. Install the needle bearing into the propel- NOTE:
ler shaft housing to the specified depth. Install an oil seal halfway into the propeller
shaft housing, then the other oil seal.
7
Bearing inner race attachment 4:

8
90890-06640

Depth d:
4.75–5.25 mm (0.187–0.207 in)

9
63P3F11 6-14
LOWR
Lower unit
3. Install the thrust washer 5 and new ball
bearing 6 onto the reverse gear 7 using
a press.

NOTE:
Install the ball bearing with the manufacture
identification mark e facing outward (propel-
ler side).

Needle bearing attachment 8:


90890-06654

4. Install the reverse gear assembly into the


propeller shaft housing using a press.

Needle bearing attachment 9:


90890-06654

6-15 63P3F11
Propeller shaft housing (regular rotation model) / Drive shaft and lower case (regular rotation model)
Drive shaft and lower case (regular rotation model) 6

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Drive shaft 1
2
3
4
5
Sleeve
Cover
Oil seal
Bolt
1
1
2
4
Not reusable
M8 × 25 mm
7
6 Drive shaft housing 1
7
8
9
10
Needle bearing
O-ring
Pinion shim
Thrust bearing

1
1

1
Not reusable
8
11 Lower case 1
12
13
14
15
Needle bearing assembly
Pinion
Forward gear shim
Taper roller bearing assembly

1
1

1 Not reusable
9
16 Needle bearing 2
17 Forward gear 1

63P3F11 6-16
LOWR
Lower unit
Removing the drive shaft
1. Remove the drive shaft, drive shaft hous-
ing, and pinion, and then pull out the for- 1
ward gear.

S69J6186

2 CAUTION:
Do not reuse the bearing, always replace
S68S6360J it with a new one.

Drive shaft holder 6 1: 90890-06520


Pinion nut holder 2: Bearing separator 1: 90890-06534
New: 90890-06715
Current: 90890-06505
2. Remove the needle bearings from the
Disassembling the drive shaft forward gear using a chisel.
housing
1. Remove the cover, oil seals, and needle
bearing.

S68S6160

CAUTION:
Do not reuse the bearing, always replace
it with a new one.
Needle bearing attachment 1:
90890-06610
Disassembling the lower case
Driver rod L3 2: 90890-06652
1. Remove the taper roller bearing outer
race and shim(s).
Disassembling the forward gear
1. Remove the taper roller bearing from the
forward gear using a press.

6-17 63P3F11
Drive shaft and lower case (regular rotation model)

NOTE:
Install the claws as shown.

Bearing outer race puller


assembly 1:
90890-06523
1
2. Remove the needle bearing.

Checking the drive shaft


2
1. Check the drive shaft for bends or wear.

3
Replace if necessary.

Ball bearing attachment 2:


90890-06636
4
Driver rod LL 3: 90890-06605

5
S69J6210

Checking the pinion and forward Checking the lower case


gear 1. Check the skeg and torpedo for cracks or
1. Check the teeth of the pinion, and the damage. Replace the lower case if nec-

6
teeth and dogs of the forward gear for essary.
cracks or wear. Replace if necessary.

7
Checking the bearings
S69J6200
8
1. Check the bearings for pitting or rum-
bling. Replace if necessary.

9
63P3F11 6-18
LOWR
Lower unit
Assembling the lower case
NOTE:
1. Install the original shim(s) and taper roller
Apply gear oil or grease to the needle bear-
bearing outer race.
ing before installation.

Assembling the forward gear


1. Install new needle bearings into the for-
ward gear to the specified depth.

CAUTION:
Add or remove shim(s), if necessary, if
replacing the forward gear or lower case.

Bearing outer race attachment 1:


Needle bearing attachment 1:
90890-06619
90890-06612
Driver rod LL 2: 90890-06605
Driver rod SS 2: 90890-06604
Bearing depth plate 3: 90890-06603
2. Install the needle bearing outer case into
the lower case.
Depth a:
20.95–21.45 mm (0.825–0.844 in)
Depth b:
4.45–4.95 mm (0.175–0.195 in)

2. Install a new taper roller bearing into the


forward gear using a press.

NOTE:
Apply gear oil to the needle bearing outer
case before installation.

Ball bearing attachment 3:


90890-06633
Bearing outer race puller
Needle bearing attachment 4:
assembly 4:
90890-06654
90890-06523

3. Install the needle bearing into the needle Assembling the drive shaft housing
bearing outer case. 1. Install the needle bearing into the drive
shaft housing to the specified depth.

6-19 63P3F11
Drive shaft and lower case (regular rotation model)
2. Install the drive shaft housing 1, thrust
bearing 2, and original shim(s) 3 onto
the drive shaft 4.

1
Needle bearing attachment 1:
2
90890-06610
Driver rod SS 2: 90890-06604
Bearing depth plate 3: 90890-06603

Depth a:
CAUTION:
Add or remove shim(s), if necessary, if
replacing the drive shaft housing or drive
3
shaft.
5.75–6.25 mm (0.226–0.246 in)

2. Apply grease to a new oil seals, and then


install them into the drive shaft housing
3. Install the sleeve, drive shaft and drive
shaft housing into the lower case, then
4
to the specified depth. the pinion and pinion nut, and then

5
tighten the nut to the specified torque.

6
6

7
S63P6310
NOTE:
Install an oil seal halfway into the drive shaft NOTE:
housing, then the other oil seal. Install the drive shaft by lifting it up slightly,
then aligning it with the pinion and the spline
of the drive shaft.
Ball bearing attachment 4:
90890-06633
Driver rod LS 5: 90890-06606 Drive shaft holder 6 5: 90890-06520
Pinion nut holder 6:
8
New: 90890-06715
Depth b:
0.25–0.75 mm (0.010–0.030 in)

Installing the drive shaft


Current: 90890-06505

Pinion nut:
9
93 N·m (9.3 kgf·m, 68.6 ft·lb)
T.

1. Install the forward gear into the lower


R.

case.
4. Tighten the drive shaft housing bolts.

63P3F11 6-20
LOWR
Lower unit
Installing the propeller shaft housing
1. Install the washer 1 and propeller shaft
assembly 2 into the propeller shaft
housing assembly 3.

2. Apply grease to a new O-ring, and then


install it onto the propeller shaft housing.

NOTE:
• To secure the ring nut, bend one tab a of
the claw washer into a slot in the ring nut.
• Bend all other tabs toward the propeller
shaft housing assembly.

Ring nut wrench 4 9: 90890-06512


Ring nut wrench extension 0:
90890-06513

3. Install the original shim(s) 4 and propel- Ring nut 8:


ler shaft housing assembly 5 into the 142 N·m (14.2 kgf·m, 104.7 ft·lb)
T.
R.

lower case, and then install the straight


key 6, claw washer 7, and ring nut 8. Installing the water pump and shift
rod
1. Install the shift rod assembly 1.

CAUTION:
Add or remove shim(s), if necessary, if
replacing the reverse gear, ball bearing,
propeller shaft housing, thrust washer, or
lower case.

2. Install a new gasket 2, the outer plate


4. Tighten the ring nut to the specified
cartridge 3, and dowels 4.
torque.

6-21 63P3F11
Drive shaft and lower case (regular rotation model)

NOTE:
• The collar and spacer should fit together
firmly.
• While pulling the drive shaft up, install the
collar with an appropriate tool a that fits
over the drive shaft as shown.
1
6. Install the new O-ring A and insert car-

C
tridge B into the pump housing C.

A
2
3
A

c b B
b

4
c
3. Install the Woodruff key into the drive S63P6360
shaft.
NOTE:
4. Align the groove in the impeller 5 with Align the insert cartridge projections b with
the Woodruff key 6, and then install the
impeller onto the drive shaft.
the holes c in the pump housing.

5
6
5. Install the washers 7, wave washer 8,
7
spacer 9, and collar 0 onto the drive

8
shaft.

9
63P3F11 6-22
LOWR
Lower unit
7. Install the new O-ring D and pump hous-
ing assembly E into the lower case,
tighten the bolts F, and then install the
seal G and cover H.

Shift rod push arm: 90890-06052

3. Install the two dowels 1 into the lower


unit.

4. Install the lower unit into the upper case,


and then tighten the lower case mounting
bolts 2 to the specified torque.

5. Install the trim tab 3 to its original posi-


tion, and then tighten the trim tab bolt 4
NOTE: to the specified torque.
• When installing the pump housing, apply
grease to the inside of the housing, and
then turn the drive shaft clockwise while
pushing down the pump housing.
• Align the cover projection d with the hole
e in the pump housing.

Installing the lower unit


1. Set the gear shift to the neutral position
at the lower unit.

2. Align the center of the set pin a with the


alignment mark b on the bottom cowl-
ing.

È X-transom model

Lower case mounting bolt 2:


47 N·m (4.7 kgf·m, 34.7 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Trim tab bolt 4:


b 42 N·m (4.2 kgf·m, 31.0 ft·lb)
a S63P3270

6-23 63P3F11
Drive shaft and lower case (regular rotation model)
6. Install the propeller and propeller nut,
and then tighten the nut finger tight. Propeller nut 5:
52 N·m (5.2 kgf·m, 38.4 ft·lb)

T.
Place a block of wood between the anti-

R.
1
cavitation plate and propeller to keep the
propeller from turning, and then tighten
the nut to the specified torque.

2
3
4
5
WARNING
6
• Do not hold the propeller with your
hands when loosening or tightening it.
• Be sure to disconnect the battery leads
from the battery and the engine stop lan-
yard from the engine stop lanyard
7
switch.
• Put a block of wood between the anti-
cavitation plate and propeller to keep
the propeller from turning.
8
NOTE:
If the grooves in the propeller nut 5 do not
align with the cotter pin hole, tighten the nut
until they are aligned.
9
63P3F11 6-24
LOWR
Lower unit
Shimming (regular rotation model) 6

F R
P

B4

T3

A3 B3

61.0

T1 T2

B1 37.0
A2
16.3
A1 B2

S63P6390

6-25 63P3F11
Shimming (regular rotation model)
Shimming
Pinion nut:
NOTE: 93 N·m (9.3 kgf·m, 68.6 ft·lb)

T.
R.
• Shimming is not required when assembling
the original lower case and inner parts.
• Shimming is required when assembling the
original inner parts and a new lower case.
• Shimming is required when replacing the
3. Measure the distance (M4) between the
special service tool and the pinion as
shown.
1
inner part(s).

Selecting the pinion shims


1. Install the special service tools onto the
2
drive shaft 1.

3
Digital caliper 4: 90890-06704

4. Turn the thrust bearing 5 two or three


4
times to seat the drive shaft housing 6,
and then measure the housing height
(M3) as shown.
5
6
NOTE:
• Select the shim thickness (T3) by using the
specified measurement(s) and the calcula-
NOTE:
7
Measure the thrust bearing at three points to
tion formula.

8
find the height average.
• Install the special service tool onto the drive
shaft so that the shaft is at the center of the
hole.
• Tighten the wing nuts another 1/4 of a turn
after they contact the fixing plate 2.

Pinion height gauge 3:


90890-06710
9
2. Install the pinion and pinion nut, and then
tighten the nut to the specified torque.

63P3F11 6-26
LOWR
Lower unit
5. Calculate the pinion shim thickness (T3) Example:
as shown in the examples below. If “T3” is 0.53 mm, then the pinion shim is
0.52 mm.
If “T3” is 0.78 mm, then the pinion shim is
0.75 mm.

Selecting the forward gear shims


1. Turn the taper roller bearing outer race
1 two or three times to seat the rollers,
and then measure the bearing height
(M1) as shown.

NOTE:
“P” is the deviation of the lower case dimen-
sion from standard. The “P” mark a is
stamped on the trim tab mounting surface of
the lower case in 0.01 mm units. If the “P”
mark is unreadable, assume that “P” is zero
and check the backlash when the unit is
assembled. T1
S63P6430

Calculation formula:
Pinion shim thickness (T3) =
80.00 + P/100 – M3 – M4

Example:
If “M3” is 46.68 mm and “M4” is 32.49 mm
and “P” is (–5), then
T3 = 80.00 + (–5)/100 – 46.68 – 32.49 mm
= 80.00 – 0.05 – 46.68 – 32.49 mm
= 0.78 mm
NOTE:
• Select the shim thickness (T1) by using the
6. Select the pinion shim(s) (T3) as follows.
specified measurement(s) and the calcula-
Calculated numeral tion formula.
Rounded numeral • Measure the bearing outer race at three
at 1/100 place
points to find the height average.
1, 2 0
3, 4, 5 2
6, 7, 8 5 Shimming plate 2: 90890-06701
Digital caliper 3: 90890-06704
9, 10 8

2. Calculate the forward gear shim thick-


Available shim thicknesses: ness (T1) as shown in the examples
0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and below.
0.50 mm

6-27 63P3F11
Shimming (regular rotation model)
Selecting the reverse gear shims
1. Install the ball bearing, thrust washer,
and reverse gear onto the propeller shaft

1
housing.

2. Measure the gear height (M2) from the


thrust washer on the propeller shaft
housing.

NOTE:
“F” is the deviation of the lower case dimen-
2
sion from standard. The “F” mark a is
stamped on the trim tab mounting surface of
the lower case in 0.01 mm units. If the “F”
mark is unreadable, assume that “F” is zero
and check the backlash when the unit is T2
3
S63P6450
assembled.

Calculation formula:
Forward gear shim thickness (T1) =
4
28.60 + F/100 – M1

Example:
If “M1” is 28.08 mm and “F” is (+5), then
T1 = 28.60 + (+5)/100 – 28.08 mm
5
= 28.60 + 0.05 – 28.08 mm
= 0.57 mm

3. Select the forward gear shim(s) (T1) as


follows.
NOTE:
• Select the shim thickness (T2) by using the
specified measurement(s) and the calcula-
6
tion formula.
• Measure the reverse gear at three points to
Calculated numeral
at 1/100 place
1, 2
3, 4, 5
Rounded numeral

0
2
find the height average.

Shimming plate 1: 90890-06701


7
Digital caliper 2: 90890-06704

8
6, 7, 8 5
9, 10 8

Available shim thicknesses:


0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and
0.50 mm

Example:
If “T1” is 0.57 mm, then the forward gear
9
shim is 0.55 mm.
If “T1” is 0.60 mm, then the forward gear
shim is 0.58 mm.

63P3F11 6-28
LOWR
Lower unit
3. Calculate the reverse gear shim thick- Example:
ness (T2) as shown in the examples If “T2” is 0.77 mm, then the reverse gear
below. shim is 0.78 mm.
If “T2” is 0.79 mm, then the reverse gear
shim is 0.80 mm.

Backlash
(regular rotation model) 6

Measuring the forward and reverse


gear backlash
1. Remove the water pump assembly.

2. Set the gear shift to the neutral position


NOTE: at the lower unit.
“R” is the deviation of the lower case dimen-
sion from standard. The “R” mark a is
stamped on the trim tab mounting surface of
the lower case in 0.01 mm units. If the “R”
mark is unreadable, assume that “R” is zero
and check the backlash when the unit is
assembled.

Calculation formula:
Reverse gear shim thickness (T2) =
M2 – 29.90 – R/100
Shift rod push arm: 90890-06052
Example:
If “M2” is 30.70 mm and “R” is (+3), then 3. Install the special service tools so that it
T2 = 30.70 – 29.90 – (+3)/100 mm pushes against the propeller shaft.
= 30.70 – 29.90 – 0.03 mm
= 0.77 mm

4. Select the reverse gear shim(s) (T2) as


follows.

Calculated numeral
Rounded numeral
at 1/100 place
1, 2 2
3, 4, 5 5
6, 7, 8 8
NOTE:
9, 10 10 Tighten the center bolt while turning the drive
shaft until the drive shaft can no longer be
Available shim thicknesses: turned.
0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and
0.50 mm

6-29 63P3F11
Shimming (regular rotation model) / Backlash (regular rotation model)

Bearing housing puller claw L 1: Forward gear


Shim thickness
90890-06502 backlash
Stopper guide plate 2: 90890-06501 Less than To be decreased by
Center bolt 3: 90890-06504

4. Install the backlash indicator onto the


0.14 mm (0.0055 in)
More than
0.46 mm (0.0181 in)
(0.30 – M) × 0.67
To be increased by
(M – 0.30) × 0.67
1
drive shaft (22.4 mm [0.88 in] in diame-
M: Measurement

2
ter), then the dial gauge onto the lower
unit.
Available shim thicknesses:
5. Set the lower unit upside down. 0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and
0.50 mm

8. Remove the special service tools from


the propeller shaft. 3
9. Apply a load to the reverse gear by
installing the propeller 8, the spacer 9
(without the washer 0), then the washer
A as shown. 4
5
NOTE:
Install the dial gauge so that the plunger a
contacts the mark b on the backlash indica-
tor.

NOTE:
6
Backlash indicator 4: 90890-06706 Tighten the propeller nut B while turning the
Magnet base plate 5: 90890-07003
Dial gauge set 6: 90890-01252
Magnet base B 7: 90890-06844
drive shaft until the drive shaft can no longer
be turned. 7
8
6. Slowly turn the drive shaft clockwise and
counterclockwise and measure the back-
lash when the drive shaft stops in each
direction.

9
Forward gear backlash:
0.14–0.46 mm (0.0055–0.0181 in)

7. Add or remove shim(s) if out of specifica-


tion.

63P3F11 6-30
LOWR
Lower unit
10. Slowly turn the drive shaft clockwise and
counterclockwise and measure the back-
lash when the drive shaft stops in each
direction.

Reverse gear backlash:


0.32–0.67 mm (0.0126–0.0264 in)

11. Add or remove shim(s) if out of specifica-


tion.

Reverse gear
Shim thickness
backlash
Less than To be increased by
0.32 mm (0.0126 in) (0.50 – M) × 0.67
More than To be decreased by
0.67 mm (0.0264 in) (M – 0.50) × 0.67

M: Measurement

Available shim thicknesses:


0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and
0.50 mm

12. Remove the special service tools, and


then install the water pump assembly.

6-31 63P3F11
Backlash (regular rotation model) / Lower unit (counter rotation model)
Lower unit (counter rotation model) 6

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Lower unit 1
2
3
4
5
Check screw
Gasket
Bolt
Drain screw
1
2
6
1
Not reusable
M10 × 45 mm 7
6 Grommet 1
7
8
9
10
Bolt
Bolt
Spacer
Propeller
1
1
1
1
M10 × 44 mm
M10 × 70 mm / L-transom model (for Europe)
8
11 Washer 1
12
13
14
15
Washer
Cotter pin
Propeller nut
Trim tab
1
1
1
1
Not reusable
9
16 Dowel 2 X-transom model
17 Water pipe 1 X-transom model

63P3F11 6-32
LOWR
Lower unit
6

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Extension 1 X-transom model
19 Bolt 6 M10 × 45 mm / X-transom model
20 Bolt 1 M10 × 200 mm / X-transom model

6-33 63P3F11
Lower unit (counter rotation model)
6

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Shift rod 1
2
3
4
5
Oil seal
Oil seal housing
O-ring
Spring
1
1
1
1
Not reusable

Not reusable 7
6 Circlip 1
7
8
9
10
Bolt
Hose nipple
O-ring
Woodruff key
3
1
1
1
M6 × 20 mm

Not reusable
8
11 Bolt 4 M8 × 45 mm
12
13
14
15
Cover
Seal
Water pump housing
O-ring
1
1
1
1 Not reusable
9
16 Insert cartridge 1
17 O-ring 1 Not reusable

63P3F11 6-34
LOWR
Lower unit
6

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Collar 1
19 Spacer 1
20 Washer 2
21 Wave washer 1
22 Impeller 1
23 Outer plate cartridge 1
24 Gasket 1 Not reusable
25 Dowel 2
26 Dowel 2

6-35 63P3F11
Lower unit (counter rotation model)
Removing the lower unit
1. Drain the gear oil. For draining proce-
dures, see Chapter 3, “Changing the

1
gear oil.”

2. Set the gear shift to the neutral position,


and place a block of wood between the
anti-cavitation plate and propeller to keep

2
the propeller from turning, and then
remove the propeller nut and propeller.

3
WARNING
È X-transom model

NOTE:
Check that there is no oil on the spline and
4
check it for wear.
• Do not hold the propeller with your
hands when loosening or tightening it.
• Be sure to disconnect the battery leads
from the battery and the engine stop lan-
yard from the engine stop lanyard
Removing the water pump and shift
rod
5
1. Remove the water pump assembly and
switch.
shift rod assembly 1.
• Put a block of wood between the anti-
cavitation plate and propeller to keep
the propeller from turning.
6
3. Mark the trim tab 1 at the area shown,
and then remove it.

4. Loosen the bolts, and then remove the


7
lower unit from the upper case.

8
9
63P3F11 6-36
LOWR
Lower unit
Checking the water pump and shift
rod
1. Check the water pump housing for defor-
mation. Replace if necessary.

S69J6360

S69J6030

2. Check the impeller 1 and insert car-


tridge 2 for cracks or wear. Replace if
necessary.

1 2

S63P6050

3. Check the Woodruff key 3 and the key-


way a in the drive shaft for wear.
Replace if necessary.

a
3

S69J6040

4. Check the shift rod for cracks or wear.


Replace if necessary.

6-37 63P3F11
Lower unit (counter rotation model) / Propeller shaft housing (counter rotation model)
Propeller shaft housing (counter rotation model) 6

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Shift rod joint 1
2
3
4
5
Ball
Shift slider
Ball
Ball
2
1
2
2
7
6 Spring 1
7
8
9
10
Dog clutch
Cross pin
Spring
Forward gear shim —
1
1
1
8
11 Forward gear 1
12
13
14
15
Thrust washer
Taper roller bearing assembly
Propeller shaft
Thrust bearing
1
1
1
1
Not reusable
9
16 Propeller shaft shim —
17 O-ring 1 Not reusable

63P3F11 6-38
LOWR
Lower unit
6

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Propeller shaft housing 1
19 Straight key 1
20 Needle bearing 1
21 Oil seal 2 Not reusable
22 Claw washer 1
23 Ring nut 1
24 Cooling water inlet cover 2
25 Nut 1
26 Screw 1

6-39 63P3F11
Propeller shaft housing (counter rotation model)
Removing the propeller shaft
housing assembly
1. Straighten the claw washer tabs a, and
1
then remove the ring nut and claw
washer.

3
2
1
2
3
S63P6500

Disassembling the forward gear


Ring nut wrench 4 1: 90890-06512 1. Remove the bearing outer race, taper
Ring nut wrench extension 2: roller bearing, and thrust washer from the
90890-06513

2. Pull out the propeller shaft housing


assembly.
forward gear.

4
1

5
6
S63P6510

Bearing separator 1: 90890-06534

Bearing housing puller claw L 3:


90890-06502
Stopper guide plate 4: 90890-06501
Center bolt 5: 90890-06504
7
Disassembling the propeller shaft
assembly
1. Remove the spring 1, then the cross pin
8
2, dog clutch 3, shift slider, balls,

9
spring, and shift rod joint.

2. Remove the forward gear assembly.

63P3F11 6-40
LOWR
Lower unit
Disassembling the propeller shaft 3. Check the bearings for pitting or rum-
housing bling. Replace if necessary.
1. Remove the oil seals and needle bear-
ing.

S69J6410

Checking the propeller shaft


1. Check the propeller shaft for bends or
Needle bearing attachment 1: wear. Replace if necessary.
90890-06653
Driver rod L3 2: 90890-06652

Checking the propeller shaft housing


1. Clean the propeller shaft housing using a
soft brush and cleaning solvent, and then
check it for cracks or damage. Replace if
necessary.
S69J6415

2. Check the dog clutch, shift rod joint, and


shift slider for cracks or wear. Replace if
necessary.

2. Check the teeth and dogs of the forward


gear for cracks or wear. Replace the
gear if necessary.

Assembling the propeller shaft


housing
1. Install the needle bearing into the propel-
ler shaft housing to the specified depth.

S62Y6640

6-41 63P3F11
Propeller shaft housing (counter rotation model)

Depth d:
4.75–5.25 mm (0.187–0.207 in)

3. Install the original shim(s) 5 and thrust


bearing 6 with the propeller shaft into
the propeller shaft housing.
1
5

NOTE:
• Install the needle bearing with the manufac-
6
2
ture identification mark a facing toward the
oil seal (propeller side).
• When using the driver rod, do not strike the
special service tool in a manner that will
force the stopper c out of place.
S63P6540
3
4
CAUTION:
Driver rod SS 1: 90890-06604 Add or remove shim(s), if necessary, if
Needle bearing attachment 2: replacing the propeller shaft, thrust bear-
90890-06610 ing, or propeller shaft housing.
Bearing depth plate 3: 90890-06603

Depth b:
24.75–25.25 mm (0.974–0.994 in)
4. Install a new taper roller bearing 7 and
the bearing outer race 8 into the propel-
ler shaft housing using a press.
5
2. Apply grease to new oil seals, and then
install them into the propeller shaft hous-
ing to the specified depth.
6
7
8
NOTE:
Ring nut wrench 9: 90890-06578
Install an oil seal halfway into the propeller
shaft housing, then the other oil seal.
9
Bearing inner race attachment 4:
90890-06640

63P3F11 6-42
LOWR
Lower unit
5. Install the thrust washer 0, forward gear
A, and dog clutch B using a press.

NOTE:
Install the dog clutch B with the “F” mark e
facing toward the forward gear.

Ring nut wrench 9: 90890-06578

6. Install the spring C, balls, and shift slider


D into the propeller shaft, and then
install the cross pin E and spring F.

F
C
E
S63P6570

6-43 63P3F11
Propeller shaft housing (counter rotation model) / Drive shaft and lower case (counter rotation model)
Drive shaft and lower case (counter rotation model) 6

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Drive shaft 1
2
3
4
5
Sleeve
Cover
Oil seal
Bolt
1
1
2
4
Not reusable
M8 × 25 mm
7
6 Drive shaft housing 1
7
8
9
10
Needle bearing
O-ring
Pinion shim
Thrust bearing

1
1

1
Not reusable
8
11 Lower case 1
12
13
14
15
Needle bearing
Pinion
Nut
Reverse gear shim —
1
1
1
9
16 Roller bearing 1
17 Thrust bearing 1

63P3F11 6-44
LOWR
Lower unit
6

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Needle bearing 2 Not reusable
19 Reverse gear 1

6-45 63P3F11
Drive shaft and lower case (counter rotation model)
Removing the drive shaft
1. Remove the drive shaft assembly and
pinion, and then pull out the reverse gear 1

1
and thrust bearing.

2
S67H6270R

Bearing separator 1: 90890-06534


2
3
S68S6360J

2. Remove the needle bearings from the


Drive shaft holder 6 1: 90890-06520 reverse gear using a chisel.
Pinion nut holder 2:
New: 90890-06715

4
Current: 90890-06505

Disassembling the drive shaft


housing
1. Remove the cover, oil seals, and needle
bearing.
S68S6160 5
Disassembling the lower case
1. Remove the roller bearing and shim(s).

6
Needle bearing attachment 1:
90890-06610
7
Driver rod L3 2: 90890-06652

Disassembling the reverse gear


1. Remove the roller bearing inner race
Bearing outer race puller
assembly 1:
8
from the reverse gear using a press. 90890-06523
Outer race puller claw B 2:
90890-06533
9
63P3F11 6-46
LOWR
Lower unit
2. Remove the needle bearing from the
lower case.

S69J6210

Checking the lower case


1. Check the skeg and torpedo for cracks or
Ball bearing attachment 3: damage. Replace the lower case if nec-
90890-06636 essary.
Driver rod LL 4: 90890-06605

Checking the pinion and reverse


gear
1. Check the teeth of the pinion, and the
teeth and dogs of the reverse gear for
cracks or wear. Replace if necessary.

Assembling the lower case


1. Install the original shim(s) and roller
bearing into the lower case.

S69J6200

Checking the bearings


1. Check the bearings for pitting or rum-
bling. Replace if necessary.

CAUTION:
Add or remove shim(s), if necessary, if
replacing the reverse gear roller bearing
or lower case.

Ball bearing attachment 1:


90890-06629
Checking the drive shaft
Driver rod LL 2: 90890-06605
1. Check the drive shaft for bends or wear.
Replace if necessary.

6-47 63P3F11
Drive shaft and lower case (counter rotation model)
2. Install the needle bearing outer case into
the lower case. Depth a:
20.95–21.45 mm (0.825–0.844 in)
Depth b:
4.45–4.95 mm (0.175–0.195 in)

2. Install the roller bearing inner race into


1
the reverse gear using a press.

2
NOTE:
Apply gear oil to the needle bearing outer
case before installation. 3
Ball bearing attachment 3:
90890-06633
Bearing outer race puller
assembly 4:
90890-06523
Bearing inner race attachment 4:
90890-06660 4
Assembling the drive shaft housing
3. Install the needle bearing into the needle
bearing outer case.

NOTE:
1. Install the needle bearing into the drive
shaft housing to the specified depth.
5
Apply gear oil or grease to the needle bear-
ing before installation.

Assembling the reverse gear


6
1. Install new needle bearings into the
reverse gear to the specified depth.

Needle bearing attachment 1:


7
90890-06610
Driver rod SS 2: 90890-06604
Bearing depth plate 3: 90890-06603
8
Depth a:

Needle bearing attachment 1:


90890-06612
5.75–6.25 mm (0.226–0.246 in)

9
Driver rod SS 2: 90890-06604
Bearing depth plate 3: 90890-06603

63P3F11 6-48
LOWR
Lower unit
2. Apply grease to new oil seals, and then 3. Install the sleeve, drive shaft, and drive
install them into the drive shaft housing shaft housing into the lower case, then
to the specified depth. the pinion and pinion nut, and then
tighten the nut to the specified torque.

6
S63P6310
NOTE:
Install an oil seal halfway into the drive shaft NOTE:
housing, then the other oil seal. Install the drive shaft by lifting it up slightly,
then aligning it with the pinion and the spline
of the drive shaft.
Ball bearing attachment 4:
90890-06633
Driver rod LS 5: 90890-06606 Drive shaft holder 6 5: 90890-06520
Pinion nut holder 6:
New: 90890-06715
Depth b:
Current: 90890-06505
0.25–0.75 mm (0.01–0.03 in)

Installing the drive shaft Pinion nut:


93 N·m (9.3 kgf·m, 68.6 ft·lb)
T.
R.

1. Install the reverse gear into the lower


case.
Installing the propeller shaft housing
2. Install the drive shaft housing 1, thrust 1. Install the original shim(s) 1 and propel-
bearing 2, and original shim(s) 3 onto ler shaft housing assembly 2 into the
the drive shaft 4. lower case, and then install the straight
key 3, claw washer 4, and ring nut 5.

CAUTION:
Add or remove shim(s), if necessary, if
replacing the drive shaft housing or drive
shaft.

6-49 63P3F11
Drive shaft and lower case (counter rotation model)

CAUTION:
Add or remove shim(s), if necessary, if

1
replacing the forward gear, taper roller
bearing, propeller shaft housing, thrust
washer, or lower case.

2. Tighten the ring nut to the specified


torque.
2
3
NOTE:
• To secure the ring nut, bend one tab a of
2. Install a new gasket 2, the outer plate
cartridge 3, and dowels 4. 4
the claw washer into a slot in the ring nut.
• Bend all other tabs toward the propeller
shaft housing assembly. 5
Ring nut wrench 4 6: 90890-06512
Ring nut wrench extension 7:
90890-06513
6
Ring nut 5:

7
142 N·m (14.2 kgf·m, 104.7 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Installing the water pump and shift


rod
1. Install the shift rod assembly 1.

8
9
63P3F11 6-50
LOWR
Lower unit
3. Install the Woodruff key into the drive
shaft. NOTE:
Align the insert cartridge projections b with
4. Align the groove in the impeller 5 with the holes c in the pump housing.
the Woodruff key 6, and then install the
impeller onto the drive shaft.
7. Install the new O-ring D and pump hous-
ing assembly E into the lower case,
tighten the bolts F, and then install the
seal G and cover H.

5. Install the washers 7, wave washer 8,


spacer 9, and collar 0 onto the drive
shaft.

NOTE:
• When installing the pump housing, apply
NOTE: grease to the inside of the housing, and
• The collar and spacer should fit together then turn the drive shaft clockwise while
firmly. pushing down the pump housing.
• While pulling the drive shaft up, install the • Align the cover projection d with the hole
collar with an appropriate tool a that fits e in the pump housing.
over the drive shaft as shown.

6. Install the new O-ring A and insert car-


tridge B into the pump housing C.

A
C
A

c b B
b

c
S63P6360

6-51 63P3F11
Drive shaft and lower case (counter rotation model)
Installing the lower unit
1. Set the gear shift to the neutral position
at the lower unit.

2. Align the center of the set pin a with the


mark b on the bottom cowling. 1
2
b
a S63P3270 3
È X-transom model

Lower case mounting bolt 2:


47 N·m (4.7 kgf·m, 34.7 ft·lb)
4
T.
R.

Trim tab bolt 4:

5
42 N·m (4.2 kgf·m, 31.0 ft·lb)

Shift rod push arm: 90890-06052

3. Install the two dowels 1 into the lower


unit.
6
7
4. Install the lower unit into the upper case,
and then tighten the lower case mounting
bolts 2 to the specified torque.

5. Install the trim tab 3 to its original posi-

8
tion, and then tighten the bolt 4 to the
specified torque.

9
63P3F11 6-52
LOWR
Lower unit
6. Install the propeller and propeller nut,
and then tighten the nut finger tight. Propeller nut 5:
52 N·m (5.2 kgf·m, 38.4 ft·lb)

T.
Place a block of wood between the anti-

R.
cavitation plate and propeller to keep the
propeller from turning, and then tighten
the nut to the specified torque.

WARNING
• Do not hold the propeller with your
hands when loosening or tightening it.
• Be sure to disconnect the battery leads
from the battery and the engine stop lan-
yard from the engine stop lanyard
switch.
• Put a block of wood between the anti-
cavitation plate and propeller to keep
the propeller from turning.

NOTE:
If the grooves in the propeller nut 5 do not
align with the cotter pin hole, tighten the nut
until they are aligned.

6-53 63P3F11
Drive shaft and lower case (counter rotation model) / Shimming (counter rotation model)
Shimming (counter rotation model) 6

F
P
R
1
2
3
B4 4
T3

A3 B3 5
61.0 6
T1 T2
7
T4
B1 36.5
B2
A1
16.7
A2
8
A4
A5
B5

B6
B7
S63P6740
9
63P3F11 6-54
LOWR
Lower unit
Shimming
Pinion nut:
NOTE: 93 N·m (9.3 kgf·m, 68.6 ft·lb)

T.
R.
• Shimming is not required when assembling
the original lower case and inner parts. 3. Measure the distance (M4) between the
• Shimming is required when assembling the special service tool and the pinion as
original inner parts and a new lower case. shown.
• Shimming is required when replacing the
inner part(s).

Selecting the pinion shims


1. Install the special service tools onto the
drive shaft 1.

Digital caliper 4: 90890-06704

4. Turn the thrust bearing 5 two or three


times to seat the drive shaft housing 6,
and then measure the housing height
(M3) as shown.

NOTE:
• Select the shim thickness (T3) by using the
NOTE:
specified measurement(s) and the calcula-
Measure the thrust bearing at three points to
tion formula.
find the height average.
• Install the special service tool onto the drive
shaft so that the shaft is at the center of the
hole. 5. Calculate the pinion shim thickness (T3)
• Tighten the wing nuts another 1/4 of a turn as shown in the examples below.
after they contact the fixing plate 2.

Pinion height gauge 3:


90890-06710

2. Install the pinion and pinion nut, and then


tighten the nut to the specified torque.

6-55 63P3F11
Shimming (counter rotation model)
Selecting the reverse gear shims
1. Turn the thrust bearing 1 two or three
times to seat the roller bearing 2, and

1
then measure the bearing height (M1) as
shown.

NOTE:
“P” is the deviation of the lower case dimen-
2
sion from standard. The “P” mark a is
stamped on the trim tab mounting surface of
the lower case in 0.01 mm units. If the “P”
mark is unreadable, assume that “P” is zero
and check the backlash when the unit is
T1 S63P6760
3
assembled.

Calculation formula:
Pinion shim thickness (T3) =
4
80.00 + P/100 – M3 – M4

Example:
If “M3” is 46.68 mm and “M4” is 32.49 mm
and “P” is (–5), then
NOTE:
5
• Select the shim thickness (T1) by using the
T3 = 80.00 + (–5)/100 – 46.68 – 32.49 mm
specified measurement(s) and the calcula-
= 80.00 – 0.05 – 46.68 – 32.49 mm
= 0.78 mm

6. Select the pinion shim(s) (T3) as follows.


tion formula.
• Measure the roller bearing at three points to
find the height average.
6
Calculated numeral
at 1/100 place
1, 2
3, 4, 5
Rounded numeral

0
2
Digital caliper 3: 90890-06704
7
8
6, 7, 8 5
9, 10 8

Available shim thicknesses:


0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and
0.50 mm

Example:
If “T3” is 0.53 mm, then the pinion shim is
9
0.52 mm.
If “T3” is 0.78 mm, then the pinion shim is
0.75 mm.

63P3F11 6-56
LOWR
Lower unit
2. Calculate the reverse gear shim thick- Example:
ness (T1) as shown in the examples If “T1” is 0.90 mm, then the reverse gear
below. shim is 0.88 mm.
If “T1” is 1.15 mm, then the reverse gear
shim is 1.12 mm.

Selecting the forward gear shims


1. Install the thrust washer 1 and taper
roller bearing 2 onto the forward gear.

NOTE:
“F” is the deviation of the lower case dimen-
sion from standard. The “F” mark a is
stamped on the trim tab mounting surface of
the lower case in 0.01 mm units. If the “F”
mark is unreadable, assume that “F” is zero
and check the backlash when the unit is 2. Measure the gear height (M2) from the
assembled. thrust washer on the taper roller bearing.

Calculation formula:
Reverse gear shim thickness (T1) =
29.10 + F/100 – M1

Example:
If “M1” is 28.25 mm and “F” is (+5), then
T1 = 29.10 + (+5)/100 – 28.25 mm
= 29.10 + 0.05 – 28.25 mm T2 S63P6790
= 0.90 mm

3. Select the reverse gear shim(s) (T1) as


follows.

Calculated numeral
Rounded numeral
at 1/100 place
1, 2 0
3, 4, 5 2
6, 7, 8 5
9, 10 8
NOTE:
• Select the shim thickness (T2) by using the
Available shim thicknesses: specified measurement(s) and the calcula-
0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and tion formula.
0.50 mm • Measure the forward gear at three points to
find the height average.

6-57 63P3F11
Shimming (counter rotation model)

Shimming plate 3: 90890-06701 Available shim thicknesses:


Digital caliper 4: 90890-06704 0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and
0.50 mm
3. Calculate the forward gear shim thick-
ness (T2) as shown in the examples
below.
Example:
If “T2” is 0.33 mm, then the forward gear
shim is 0.35 mm.
1
If “T2” is 0.79 mm, then the forward gear
shim is 0.80 mm.

Selecting the propeller shaft shims


1. Turn the taper roller bearing outer race
2
1 two or three times to seat the rollers,
and then measure the bearing height
(M6) as shown. 3
NOTE:
“R” is the deviation of the lower case dimen-
sion from standard. The “R” mark a is
stamped on the trim tab mounting surface of
4
the lower case in 0.01 mm units. If the “R”
mark is unreadable, assume that “R” is zero
and check the backlash when the unit is
assembled. T´4 S63P6820 5
Calculation formula:
Forward gear shim thickness (T2) =
M2 – 29.50 – R/100

Example:
6
If “M2” is 29.84 mm and “R” is (+1), then
T2 = 29.84 – 29.50 – (+1)/100 mm
= 29.84 – 29.50 – 0.01 mm
= 0.33 mm
NOTE:
7
4. Select the forward gear shim(s) (T2) as • Select the shim thickness (T’4) by using the
follows.

Calculated numeral
at 1/100 place
Rounded numeral
specified measurement(s) and the calcula-
tion formula.
• Measure the taper roller bearing at three
points to find the height average.
8
1, 2 2
3, 4, 5
6, 7, 8
9, 10
5
8
10
Shimming plate 2: 90890-06701
Digital caliper 3: 90890-06704
9
63P3F11 6-58
LOWR
Lower unit
2. Install the thrust bearing 4 onto the pro- 4. Round the numerals for the propeller
peller shaft 5, and then measure the shaft shim(s) (T4) as follows.
propeller shaft flange and thrust bearing
thickness (M7) as shown. Calculated numeral
Rounded numeral
at 1/100 place
1, 2 0
3, 4, 5 2
6, 7, 8 5
9, 10 8

Example:
If “T4” is 0.94 mm, then the propeller shaft
shim is 0.92 mm.
If “T4” is 1.00 mm, then the propeller shaft
shim is 0.98 mm.
3. Calculate the propeller shaft shim thick-
ness (T4) as shown in the examples 5. Calculate and select the propeller shaft
below. shim thickness (T’4) as shown in the
examples below.

Calculation formula 2:
Propeller shaft shim thickness (T’4) =
T4 – 0.30

Example:
If “T4” is 0.92 mm, then
a b T’4 = 0.92 – 0.30 mm
S69J6626
= 0.62 mm
NOTE: Available shim thicknesses:
“A” and “B” are the deviation of the propeller
0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and
shaft housing dimension from standard. The
0.50 mm
“A” mark a and “B” mark b are stamped on
the propeller shaft housing in 0.01 mm units.
6. If the “A” mark or “B” mark is unreadable,
If the “A” mark or “B” mark is unreadable,
measure the propeller shaft free play as
assume that “A” and “B” are zero and check
shown.
the free play when the unit is assembled.
7. Install the shim(s) 6, thrust bearing 4,
Calculation formula 1: propeller shaft 5, and taper roller bear-
Propeller shaft shim thickness (T4) = ing 7 into the propeller shaft housing.
29.30 – A/100 + B/100 – M6 – M7

Example:
If “M6” is 15.70 mm and “M7” is 12.55 mm
and “A” is (+6) and “B” is (–5), then
T4 = 29.30 – (+6)/100 + (–5)/100 – 15.70 – 12.55 mm
= 29.30 – 0.06 – 0.05 – 15.70 – 12.55 mm
= 0.94 mm

6-59 63P3F11
Shimming (counter rotation model) / Backlash (counter rotation model)
8. Measure the propeller shaft free play.
Repeat steps 1–7 if out of specification.

1
NOTE:
Tighten the center bolt while turning the drive
2
Propeller shaft free play: shaft until the drive shaft can no longer be
0.25–0.35 mm (0.0098–0.0138 in)

Magnet base B 8: 90890-06844


turned.

Bearing housing puller claw L 1:


3
Dial gauge set 9: 90890-01252 90890-06502

Backlash
(counter rotation model) 6
Stopper guide plate 2: 90890-06501
Center bolt 3: 90890-06504

4. Install the backlash indicator onto the


4
Measuring the forward and reverse drive shaft (22.4 mm [0.88 in] in diame-
gear backlash
1. Remove the water pump assembly.

2. Set the gear shift to the neutral position


ter), then the dial gauge onto the lower
unit. 5
at the lower unit.

6
7
Shift rod push arm: 90890-06052 8
3. Install the special service tools so that it
pushes against the propeller shaft.
9
63P3F11 6-60
LOWR
Lower unit
5. Set the lower unit upside down. 8. Remove the special service tools from
the propeller shaft.

9. Install the propeller 8, the spacer 9


(without the washer 0), then the washer
A as shown.

NOTE:
Install the dial gauge so that the plunger a NOTE:
contacts the mark b on the backlash indica- Tighten the propeller nut B while turning the
tor. propeller until the propeller can no longer be
turned.

Backlash indicator 4: 90890-06706


Magnet base plate 5: 90890-07003 10. Turn the shift rod to the reverse position
Dial gauge set 6: 90890-01252 c with the shift rod push arm.
Magnet base B 7: 90890-06844
11. Turn the drive shaft clockwise until the
dog clutch C is fully engaged.
6. Slowly turn the drive shaft clockwise and
counterclockwise and measure the back-
lash when the drive shaft stops in each
direction.

Forward gear backlash:


0.14–0.42 mm (0.0055–0.0165 in)

7. Add or remove shim(s) if out of specifica-


tion.

Forward gear
Shim thickness 12. Turn the shift rod to the neutral position
backlash
d with the shift rod push arm.
Less than To be increased by
0.14 mm (0.0055 in) (0.28 – M) × 0.67 13. Turn the drive shaft counterclockwise
More than To be decreased by approximately 30°.
0.42 mm (0.0165 in) (M – 0.28) × 0.67

M: Measurement

Available shim thicknesses:


0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and
0.50 mm

6-61 63P3F11
Backlash (counter rotation model)

Available shim thicknesses:


0.10, 0.12, 0.15, 0.18, 0.30, 0.40, and
0.50 mm

17. Remove the special service tools, and


then install the water pump assembly.
1
14. Turn the shift rod to the reverse position
2
c with the shift rod push arm.

15. Slowly turn the drive shaft clockwise and


counterclockwise and measure the back-
lash when the drive shaft stops in each
3
direction.

4
5
NOTE:
When measuring the reverse gear backlash,
turn the shift rod push arm towards the
reverse position c with force.
6
Reverse gear backlash:
0.23–0.58 mm (0.0090–0.0228 in)
7
16. Add or remove shim(s) if out of specifica-
tion.

Reverse gear
backlash
Shim thickness
8
Less than To be decreased by
0.23 mm (0.0090 in)
More than
0.58 mm (0.0228 in)
(0.41 – M) × 0.67
To be increased by
(M – 0.41) × 0.67
9
M: Measurement

63P3F11 6-62
LOWR
Lower unit

— MEMO —

6-63 63P3F11
BRKT

Bracket unit

Special service tools .....................................................................................7-1

Bottom cowling .............................................................................................. 7-2 1


Upper case, steering arm, swivel bracket and clamp brackets ................. 7-6
Draining the engine oil............................................................................. 7-12
Disassembling the oil pan........................................................................7-12
Checking the oil strainer ..........................................................................7-12
Assembling the oil pan ............................................................................7-12
2
Removing the steering arm ..................................................................... 7-14

3
Installing the steering arm ....................................................................... 7-14
Installing the upper case..........................................................................7-15

Clamp brackets ............................................................................................ 7-16


Removing the clamp brackets .................................................................7-18

4
Installing the clamp brackets ................................................................... 7-18
Adjusting the trim sensor cam .................................................................7-18

Power trim and tilt unit ................................................................................ 7-20


Removing the power trim and tilt unit ......................................................7-27
Checking the hydraulic pressure ............................................................. 7-28
Disassembling the power trim and tilt motor............................................7-30
Checking the power trim and tilt motor ....................................................7-31
Assembling the power trim and tilt motor ................................................ 7-33
5
Removing the reservoir ...........................................................................7-33

6
Disassembling the gear pump housing ...................................................7-34
Checking the gear pump .........................................................................7-35
Assembling the gear pump housing ........................................................ 7-35
Disassembling the tilt cylinder and trim cylinder...................................... 7-37
Checking the tilt cylinder and trim cylinder .............................................. 7-38
Assembling the tilt piston and trim pistons .............................................. 7-39
Assembling the power trim and tilt unit....................................................7-40
Bleeding the power trim and tilt unit ........................................................ 7-43
Installing the power trim and tilt unit ........................................................ 7-44
Bleeding the power trim and tilt unit (built-in) ..........................................7-45
7
Power trim and tilt electrical system.......................................................... 7-46
Checking the fuse....................................................................................7-47
Checking the power trim and tilt relay .....................................................7-47
Checking the power trim and tilt switch ...................................................7-47
8
Checking the trim sensor.........................................................................7-48

9
63P3F11
BRKT
Bracket unit
Special service tools 7

Up relief fitting
90890-06773
Down relief fitting
90890-06774

Hydraulic pressure gauge


90890-06776

Trim and tilt wrench


New: 90890-06587
Current: 90890-06548

7-1 63P3F11
Special service tools / Bottom cowling
Bottom cowling 7

11

4
12
13
3
7
A

10 1
5 1

16
A
A
14
6 8

7
34
2
9
2
17

20
15
A
33
3
A
18
24 19

25
26
21
22
23 28 4
27
A

3 N · m (0.3 kgf · m, 2.2 ft · Ib)


32
5
T.
R.

31

6
18 N · m (1.8 kgf · m, 13.3 ft · Ib)
T.

29 30
R.

S63P7080

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Bracket 1
2
3
4
5
Shift cut switch
Bracket
Neutral switch
Screw
1
1
1
2 ø4 × 16 mm
7
6 Plate 1
7
8
9
10
Bushing
Grease nipple
Bolt
Bolt
2
1
1
2 M6 × 50 mm
8
11 Screw 2 ø4 × 16 mm
12
13
14
15
Plate
Bushing
Washer
Shift lever
1
1
1
1
9
16 Bushing 1
17 Shift rod 1

63P3F11 7-2
BRKT
Bracket unit
7

11
12 A
13
10
3
7
4
5 1
6 8
A
16
14
A 7
34
9
2
17 A
33
15
20
A
18
24 19 21
22
25 23 28
26
27
A 32

3 N · m (0.3 kgf · m, 2.2 ft · Ib)


T.
R.

31
18 N · m (1.8 kgf · m, 13.3 ft · Ib)
T.

29 30
R.

S63P7080

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Spacer 1
19 Bushing 1
20 Bolt 1 M6 × 35 mm
21 Bracket 1
22 Ball 1
23 Bolt 1
24 Grease nipple 1
25 Spacer 1
26 Circlip 1
27 Grommet 1
28 Screw 2 ø6 × 20 mm
29 Adapter 1
30 Hose joint 1
31 Flushing hose 1
32 Grommet 1
33 Trim sensor coupler 1
34 PTT motor lead 1

7-3 63P3F11
Bottom cowling
7

31
30
34
1
29

2
23 20
24 27 28
22 19
26
25
21 A

15 14 13
18
A

11
32
LT
572
4
5
33
3
12 9 10

16
17
9
8
6 1
7 3

2
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
S63P7070
6
1 Bottom cowling 1
2
3
4
5
Rubber seal
Grommet
Bolt
Grommet
1
2
4
4
M8 × 35 mm 7
6 Grommet 4
7
8
9
10
Collar
Cowling lock lever
Bushing
Plate
4
2
4
2
8
11 Bolt 4 M6 × 30 mm
12
13
14
15
Wave washer
Lever
Washer
Bolt
2
2
2
2 M6 × 20 mm
9
16 Stay 2
17 Bolt 2 M6 × 20 mm

63P3F11 7-4
BRKT
Bracket unit
7

34
31
30

23 20 29
24 27 28
22 19
26
25
21 A

18 32
15 14 13 A

11 LT 4
33
572 5
12 9 10
17 6 1
7 3
9
8
16 2

S63P7070

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Grommet 1
19 Holder 1
20 Bolt 1 M6 × 20 mm
21 Retaining plate 1
22 Bolt 2 M6 × 30 mm
23 Cable holder 1
24 Bolt 2 M6 × 20 mm
25 Cable holder 1
26 Bolt 1 M6 × 20 mm
27 Cable holder 1
28 Bolt 1 M6 × 20 mm
29 Bracket 2
30 Bolt 4 M6 × 20 mm
31 Power trim and tilt switch 1
32 Water outlet 1
33 Cover 1
34 Rubber trim 1

7-5 63P3F11
Bottom cowling / Upper case, steering arm, swivel bracket and clamp brackets
Upper case, steering arm, swivel bracket and clamp brackets 7

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Upper case assembly 1
2
3
4
5
Cover
Ground lead
Bolt
Bolt
2
1
1
1
M6 × 10 mm
M6 × 17 mm
7
6 Adapter 1
7
8
9
10
Plastic tie
Hose
Circlip
Nut
1
1
1
2
Not reusable

8
11 Nut 2
12
13
14
15
Washer
Steering yoke
Washer
Bushing
4
1
2
1
9
16 O-ring 2 Not reusable
17 Bushing 2

63P3F11 7-6
BRKT
Bracket unit
7

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Steering arm 1
19 Washer 2
20 Washer 2
21 Trim stopper 2
22 Nut 2
23 Bolt 4

7-7 63P3F11
Upper case, steering arm, swivel bracket and clamp brackets
7

54 N · m (5.4 kgf · m, 39.8 ft · Ib)

T.
1
16

R.
LT

30 572
4 N · m (0.4 kgf · m, 3.0 ft · Ib)
T.
R.

20 N · m (2.0 kgf · m, 14.8 ft · Ib) 17


2120
T.
R.

5
22
19 18
27 N · m (2.7 kgf · m, 20.0 ft · Ib)
2

T.
R.
A
6 23
LT 42 N · m (4.2 kgf · m, 31.0 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
3
271
24
3 LT LT
572 572

1 2

25
4
9 28 29

5
10 27 4
11
12 26
13
7 14 A
15

6
8
S63P7100

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Upper case 1
2
3
4
5
Dowel
Grommet
Damper
Screw
2
1
1
2 ø5 × 15 mm
7
6 Baffle plate 1
7
8
9
10
Drive shaft bushing
Circlip
Cap
Bolt
1
1
2
2 M14 × 225 mm
8
11 Washer 2
12
13
14
15
Washer
Washer
Lower mount
Washer
2
2
2
2
9
16 Bolt 3 M10 × 45 mm
17 Bolt 2 M14 × 205 mm

63P3F11 7-8
BRKT
Bracket unit
7

54 N · m (5.4 kgf · m, 39.8 ft · Ib)

T.
16

R.
LT

30 572
4 N · m (0.4 kgf · m, 3.0 ft · Ib)
T.
R.

20 N · m (2.0 kgf · m, 14.8 ft · Ib) 17


2120
T.
R.

22
5 19 18
27 N · m (2.7 kgf · m, 20.0 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
A
6 23
LT 42 N · m (4.2 kgf · m, 31.0 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
271
24
3 LT LT
572 572

1 2

25
9 28 29
10 27 4
11
12 26
13
7 14 A
15
8
S63P7100

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Washer 2
19 Washer 2
20 Upper mount 2
21 Washer 2
22 Collar 2
23 Bolt 2 M8 × 30 mm
24 Bolt 4 M10 × 45 mm
25 Muffler assembly 1
26 Gasket 1 Not reusable
27 Rubber seal 1
28 Washer 1
29 Drain bolt 1 M14 × 12 mm
30 Bracket 1

7-9 63P3F11
Upper case, steering arm, swivel bracket and clamp brackets
7

20

LT
11

10
1
572
9
20 N · m (2.0 kgf · m, 14.8 ft · Ib)
2
T.
R.
8
19
A

10 N · m (1.0 kgf · m, 7.4 ft · Ib) 18 7 6 3


T.
R.

16
17
15
14

13
4
3
4
12
LT
572
A
5

5
2 LT
20 N · m (2.0 kgf · m, 14.8 ft · Ib) 572

6
T.

20 N · m (2.0 kgf · m, 14.8 ft · Ib)


R.

1
T.

S63P7110
R.

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Bolt 8 M8 × 35 mm
2
3
4
5
Muffler
Dowel
Pipe
Rubber seal
1
2
1
1
7
6 Gasket 2 Not reusable
7
8
9
10
Plate
Gasket
Bolt
Exhaust manifold
1
1
4
1
Not reusable
M8 × 60 mm
8
11 Gasket 1 Not reusable
12
13
14
15
Bolt
Oil pan
Dowel
Bolt
10
1
2
3
M8 × 35 mm

M6 × 25 mm
9
16 Collar 3
17 Oil strainer 1

63P3F11 7-10
BRKT
Bracket unit
7

20
11

LT
572 10
9
20 N · m (2.0 kgf · m, 14.8 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
8
19
A

10 N · m (1.0 kgf · m, 7.4 ft · Ib) 18 7 6


T.
R.

16
17
15
14

4
13 3
12
5
LT
A
572

2 LT
20 N · m (2.0 kgf · m, 14.8 ft · Ib) 572
T.

20 N · m (2.0 kgf · m, 14.8 ft · Ib)


R.

1
T.

S63P7110
R.

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Gasket 1 Not reusable
19 Gasket 1 Not reusable
20 Exhaust guide 1

7-11 63P3F11
Upper case, steering arm, swivel bracket and clamp brackets
Draining the engine oil
1. Place a drain pan under the drain hole,
and then remove the drain bolt 1 and let

1
the oil drain completely.

2
2. Remove the upper and lower mounting
nut, and then remove the upper case. 4
6
3
S63P7160

4
3. Remove the muffler assembly from the
upper case. Checking the oil strainer
1. Check the oil strainer for dirt and residue.
Disassembling the oil pan Clean if necessary.
1. Remove the muffler 1, plate 2, and
exhaust manifold 3 from the oil pan 4. Assembling the oil pan
1. Install the new gasket 1 onto the
exhaust guide 2.
5
4 2

2
1 6
3
S63P7170 7
2. Install the oil strainer 3 and bolts, and

S63P7150
then tighten the bolts to the specified
torque.

3
8
2. Remove the oil pan 4 from the exhaust
guide 5.

3. Remove the oil strainer 6 from the


9
exhaust guide 5.

S63P7180

63P3F11 7-12
BRKT
Bracket unit

Oil strainer bolt:


10 N·m (1.0 kgf·m, 7.4 ft·lb)
T.
R.

3. Install the oil pan 4, and then tighten the 8


bolts finger tight.
0
4. Install the exhaust manifold 5 and bolts,
and then tighten the bolts finger tight.

5. Tighten the exhaust manifold bolts 6,


then the oil pan bolts 7, and then tighten
LT
them to the specified torques. 572

9 A

A
4
7 5 6 S63P7200

Muffler bolt:
20 N·m (2.0 kgf·m, 14.8 ft·lb)
T.
R.

LT
9. Install the muffler assembly A by insert-
LT
572
572
ing the tip of the cooling water pipe B
into the joint hole a of the upper case.

10. Install muffler assembly bolts C and D,


and then tighten them to the specified
torques.
S63P7190
C D
LT
572
Exhaust manifold bolt 6: LT
572
20 N·m (2.0 kgf·m, 14.8 ft·lb)
T.
R.

LT
Oil pan bolt 7: 271
20 N·m (2.0 kgf·m, 14.8 ft·lb) A

A
6. Install the plate 8.
B
7. Install the cooling water pipe 9 into the
muffler 0.
A

8. Install the muffler 0 and bolts into the oil


B
pan, and then tighten the bolts to the
specified torque.

a S63P7210

7-13 63P3F11
Upper case, steering arm, swivel bracket and clamp brackets
3. Remove the steering arm from the swivel
Muffler assembly bolt C: bracket by pulling the arm off the bracket.
20 N·m (2.0 kgf·m, 14.8 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Muffler assembly bolt D: Installing the steering arm


42 N·m (4.2 kgf·m, 31.0 ft·lb)

11. Install the upper mounts E and bolts into


1. Install the washer 1 and bushing 2 onto
the steering arm 3. 1
the upper case. 2. Place the swivel bracket 4 in an upright

2
position, and then install the steering arm
12. Install the bracket F and bolts, and then onto the swivel bracket.
tighten the bolts to the specified torque.

3
4
Upper mount bracket bolt:
3. Install the bushing 5, new O-ring 6,
bushing 7, and washer 8 onto the
5
54 N·m (5.4 kgf·m, 39.8 ft·lb) swivel bracket.
T.
R.

Removing the steering arm


1. Remove the circlip 1.
6
2. Remove the steering yoke 2 by striking
it with a plastic hammer.
7
8
9
63P3F11 7-14
BRKT
Bracket unit
4. Install the steering yoke 9 to the steer- Installing the upper case
ing arm 3 by aligning the center a of 1. Install the upper and lower mounting
the yoke with the center b of the steer- bolts into the swivel bracket 1 simulta-
ing arm. neously.

5. Install the circlip 0. 2. Install the upper mounting nut 2 and


lower mounting nut 3, and then tighten
them to the specified torques.

3. Install the covers 4.

6. Inject grease into the grease nipple until


grease comes out from both the upper
and lower bushings c.

Upper mounting nut 2:


74 N·m (7.4 kgf·m, 54.6 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Lower mounting nut 3:


74 N·m (7.4 kgf·m, 54.6 ft·lb)

7-15 63P3F11
Upper case, steering arm, swivel bracket and clamp brackets / Clamp brackets
Clamp brackets 7

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Swivel bracket 1
2
3
4
5
Clamp bracket
Clamp bracket
Self-locking nut
Grease nipple
1
1
1
6
7
6 Ground lead 3
7
8
9
10
Washer
Bolt
Washer
Bushing
1
1
2
6
M6 × 11 mm
8
11 Trim sensor 1
12
13
14
15
Screw
Trim sensor cam
Screw
Clamp
2
1
1
1
ø6 × 15 mm

ø6 × 25 mm
9
16 Bolt 4 M6 × 30 mm
17 Bracket 2

63P3F11 7-16
BRKT
Bracket unit
7

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Anode 1
19 Through tube 1
20 Bolt 1 M8 × 20 mm
21 Tilt stop lever 1
22 Bush 4
23 Collar 1
24 Distance collar 2
25 Spring pin 2
26 Pin 1
27 Spring 1
28 Spring hook 1
29 Bolt 1 M6 × 10 mm
30 Tilt stop lever 1

7-17 63P3F11
Clamp brackets
Removing the clamp brackets
1. Remove the power trim and tilt unit. For Self-locking nut:
15 N·m (1.5 kgf·m, 11.1 ft·lb)

T.
R.
removal procedures, see “Removing the

1
power trim and tilt unit.”
5. Install the power trim and tilt unit, then
2. Remove the anode. the anode.

3. Remove the bolt and grease nipples, and NOTE:


Install the ground lead between the power

2
then disconnect the ground leads.
trim and tilt unit and the anode.
4. Remove the self-locking nut and bolt.

5. Remove the through tube, then disas- 6. Install the ground lead between the
semble the clamp brackets, trim sensor clamp brackets and the swivel bracket.
cam, and swivel bracket.

6. Remove the trim sensor.


7. Apply water resistant grease through the
grease nipples.
3
7. Remove the tilt stop levers.

4
A

A
Installing the clamp brackets
1. Install the tilt stop levers onto the swivel
bracket assembly.

2. Install the trim sensor 1 and bushings


onto the swivel bracket assembly.
a
5
LT
1 6
A
271

S60X7140

3. Assemble the clamp brackets, washers,


NOTE:
Apply the grease until it comes out of the
S63P7320

7
and swivel bracket, and then install the bushing a.
through tube.

NOTE:
• Make sure that the trim sensor cam is
Adjusting the trim sensor cam
1. Fully retract the power trim and tilt unit.
8
installed between the swivel bracket holes.
• Adjust the trim sensor cam after assembly.

4. Install the bolts on the through tube, and


2. Loosen the trim sensor cam screw 1.

3. Adjust the trim sensor cam 2 where the


specified trim sensor setting resistance is
9
then tighten the self-locking nut to the obtained.
specified torque.

63P3F11 7-18
BRKT
Bracket unit

Trim sensor resistance:


Pink (P) – Black (B)
2 B 238.8–378.8 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F)
Gy

1
S60X7160

Trim sensor setting resistance:


Pink (P) – Black (B)
9–11 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F)

Trim sensor cam screw 1:


2 N·m (0.2 kgf·m, 1.5 ft·lb)
T.
R.

4. Fully tilt the outboard motor up, and then


support it with the tilt stop lever 3.

S60X7170

WARNING
After tilting up the outboard motor, be
sure to support it with the tilt stop lever.
Otherwise, the outboard motor could sud-
denly lower if the power trim and tilt unit
should lose fluid pressure.

5. Check the trim sensor resistance. If the


resistance is out of specification, adjust
the trim sensor cam position and check
the trim sensor.

7-19 63P3F11
Clamp brackets / Power trim and tilt unit
Power trim and tilt unit 7

3
A 5 1
A

2
9

4 9

1
3
7
8
7
6
4
6 9

5
9

A A

A
11 10
LT

No.
242

Part name Q’ty Remarks


S60X7010
6
1 Power trim and tilt unit 1
2
3
4
5
PTT motor lead
Shaft
Plastic tie
Circlip
2
1
3
1
Not reusable 7
6 Bolt 2 M8 × 16 mm
7
8
9
10
Washer
Shaft
Bushing
Bolt
2
1
6
1 M6 × 10 mm
8
11 Ground lead 1

9
63P3F11 7-20
BRKT
Bracket unit
7

7
1
0.7 N · m (0.07 kgf · m, 0.5 ft · lb)
T.
R.

8 5 N · m (0.5 kgf · m, 3.7 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
2
9
3
4 10
5

5 N · m (0.5 kgf · m, 3.7 ft · Ib)


T.
R.

S60X7180

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Power trim and tilt motor 1
2 Reservoir 1
3 Reservoir cap 1
4 O-ring 1
5 O-ring 1 Not reusable
6 Bolt 3 M6 × 14 mm
7 Bolt 4 M6 × 35 mm
8 O-ring 1 Not reusable
9 Filter 1
10 Joint 1

7-21 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
7

1
2
3
4
5
No. Part name Q’ty Remarks
6
1 Screw 1 ø4 × 15 mm
2
3
4
5
Stator
Armature
O-ring
Screw
1
1
1
2
Not reusable
ø4 × 12 mm
7
6 Brush holder 1
7
8
9
10
Brush 2
Brush 1
Brush holder
Brush spring
1
1
1
2
8
11 PTT motor base 1
12
13
14
Oil seal
Bearing
Screw
1
1
2
Not reusable
Not reusable
ø4 × 15 mm
9
63P3F11 7-22
BRKT
Bracket unit
7

6 N · m (0.6 kgf · m, 4.4 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
1
8 N · m (0.8 kgf · m, 5.9 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
28 26
27 15
25 16
17 3
18 4
22 5 2
21 19
24 6
23 7
20

8 N · m (0.8 kgf · m, 5.9 ft · Ib) 14


9
T.
R.

13
12
11
3 N · m (0.3 kgf · m, 2.2 ft · Ib) 10
T.
R.

S60X7200

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Bolt 4 M5 × 16 mm
2 Gear pump assembly 1
3 Ball 2
4 Shuttle piston 2
5 O-ring 2 Not reusable
6 Main valve 2
7 Ball 2
8 Bolt 1
9 Bolt 2
10 Circlip 1
11 Manual valve 1
12 O-ring 1 Not reusable
13 O-ring 1 Not reusable
14 Backup ring 1
15 Spring 1
16 Absorber valve pin 1
17 Ball 1

7-23 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
7

6 N · m (0.6 kgf · m, 4.4 ft · Ib)


1
T.
R.
1
8 N · m (0.8 kgf · m, 5.9 ft · Ib)

T.
R.
28 26
27 15
25 16

24
23
22
21
17
18
19
3
4
5
6
2 3
7

4
20

8 N · m (0.8 kgf · m, 5.9 ft · Ib)


9 14
5
T.
R.

13
12
11

6
3 N · m (0.3 kgf · m, 2.2 ft · Ib) 10
T.
R.

S60X7200

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Up-relief valve seat 1
19
20
21
22
O-ring
Filter
O-ring
Down-relief valve
1
2
1
1
Not reusable

Not reusable 7
23 Valve pin 1
24
25
26
27
O-ring
Valve seat
Pin
Ball
4
1
1
1
Not reusable

8
28 O-ring 1 Not reusable

9
63P3F11 7-24
BRKT
Bracket unit
7

1 13
A
16
15
13
14
130 N · m (13.0 kgf · m, 96.0 ft · lb)
T.
R.
15
16 19
18 A
17
18
22
19 23 7 7
20 8
24
4
21 9 8
10
5 78 N · m (7.8 kgf · m, 57.5 ft · lb)
2
T.
R.
5
6 6
11
11
12 12
3
96 N · m (9.6 kgf · m, 70.8 ft · Ib)
T.
R.

S63P7350

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


1 Tilt ram 1
2 Trim ram 2
3 Cylinder body 1
4 Free piston 1
5 Backup ring 1
6 O-ring 1 Not reusable
7 Dust seal 2 Not reusable
8 Seal 2 Not reusable
9 Trim cylinder end screw 2
10 O-ring 2 Not reusable
11 Backup ring 2
12 O-ring 2 Not reusable
13 Dust seal 1 Not reusable
14 Tilt cylinder end screw 1
15 O-ring 1 Not reusable
16 O-ring 1 Not reusable
17 Tilt piston 1

7-25 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
7

A
1 13
15
16 1
13
14
15
16
18
T.
R.
130 N · m (13.0 kgf · m, 96.0 ft · lb)

19
A
2
17
18
19
20
22
23
24 8
7 7 3
4
21

5
10
2
9

T.
8
78 N · m (7.8 kgf · m, 57.5 ft · lb) 4
R.
5
6 6
11

3
96 N · m (9.6 kgf · m, 70.8 ft · Ib)
11
12 12
5
T.
R.

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


S63P7350
6
18 O-ring 1 Not reusable
19
20
21
22
O-ring
Washer
Nut
Ball
1
1
1
4
Not reusable

7
23 Valve 4
24 Spring 4

8
9
63P3F11 7-26
BRKT
Bracket unit
Removing the power trim and tilt unit 2. Remove the bolt and disconnect the
1. Fully tilt the outboard motor up, and then ground lead at the bottom of the power
support it with the tilt stop lever 1. trim and tilt unit.

3. Remove the plastic ties, and then pull out


1
the PTT motor leads.

S60X3020

4. Remove the bolts, then the lower mount-


ing shaft.

WARNING
After tilting up the outboard motor, be
sure to support it with the tilt stop lever.
Otherwise, the outboard motor could sud-
denly lower if the power trim and tilt unit
should lose fluid pressure.

NOTE:
• If the power trim and tilt does not operate,
loosen the manual valve 2 and tilt the out-
board motor up manually.
• If the manual valve is loosened, be sure to S60X7110
tighten it to the specified torque after tilting
the outboard motor up. 5. Remove the circlip, then the upper
mounting shaft.
Manual valve:
3 N·m (0.3 kgf·m, 2.2 ft·lb)
T.
R.

7-27 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit

Recommended power trim and tilt


fluid:
ATF Dexron II

3. Install the reservoir cap, and then tighten


it to the specified torque.
1
2
Reservoir cap:
0.7 N·m (0.07 kgf·m, 0.5 ft·lb)

T.
R.
4. Fully extend the trim and tilt rams.

3
5. Remove the circlip 1, then the manual
valve 2.

6. Install the up relief fitting 3 and hydraulic


S60X7120 pressure gauge 4.

NOTE:
Hold the power trim and tilt unit with one
hand, and pull the upper mount shaft out at a
4
downward angle with the other.

6. Remove the collars.

Checking the hydraulic pressure


5
1. Remove the reservoir cap, and then
check the fluid level in the reservoir.
6
7
NOTE:

NOTE:
S60X7340

If the fluid is at the correct level, the fluid


Quickly install the special service tools before
any fluid flows out of the hole.
8
Up relief fitting 3: 90890-06773
should overflow out of the filler hole when the Hydraulic pressure gauge 4:
reservoir cap is removed.

2. If necessary, add sufficient fluid of the


90890-06776
9
recommended type until it overflows out
of the filler hole.

63P3F11 7-28
BRKT
Bracket unit
7. Connect the PTT motor leads to the bat-
tery terminals to fully retract the trim and
tilt rams.

Down relief fitting 5: 90890-06774


Hydraulic pressure gauge:
90890-06776
Battery
Rams PTT motor lead
terminal 10. Remove the reservoir cap, and then
Light green (Lg) + check the fluid level.
Down
Sky blue (Sb) -

8. Reverse the PTT motor leads between


the battery terminals to fully extend the
trim and tilt rams, and then measure the
hydraulic pressure.

S60X7340

NOTE:
If the fluid is at the correct level, the fluid
should overflow out of the filler hole when the
reservoir cap is removed.

Battery 11. If necessary, add sufficient fluid of the


Rams PTT motor lead
terminal recommended type until it overflows out
Sky blue (Sb) + of the filler hole.
Up
Light green (Lg) -
Recommended power trim and tilt
fluid:
Hydraulic pressure (up): ATF Dexron II
10–12 MPa (100–120 kgf/cm2)
12. Install the reservoir cap, and then tighten
9. Replace the up relief fitting with the down it to the specified torque.
relief fitting 5.
Reservoir cap:
NOTE:
0.7 N·m (0.07 kgf·m, 0.5 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Quickly install the special service tools before


any fluid flows out of the hole.

7-29 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
13. Connect the PTT motor leads to the bat-
tery terminals to fully retract the trim and NOTE:
tilt rams, and then measure the hydraulic Quickly install the manual valve before any
fluid flows out of the hole.

1
pressure. If out of specification, overhaul
the power trim and tilt unit.
Disassembling the power trim and
tilt motor
1. Remove the power trim and tilt motor, O-
ring, gear pump filter, and joint from the
gear pump housing. 2
Rams PTT motor lead
Battery
3
terminal
+

4
Light green (Lg)
Down
Sky blue (Sb) -

Hydraulic pressure (down):


6–9 MPa (60–90 kgf/cm2)

14. Reverse the PTT motor leads between


the battery terminals to fully extend the CAUTION:
S60X7220

5
trim and tilt rams. • Make sure that the trim and tilt rams are

6
fully extended when removing the power
trim and tilt motor, otherwise fluid can
spurt out from the unit due to internal
pressure.
• Do not push the trim and tilt rams down
while the power trim and tilt motor is
removed from the power trim and tilt
unit, otherwise fluid can spurt out. 7
8
2. Check the gear pump filter for dirt or resi-
Battery due and for damage. Clean or replace if
Rams PTT motor lead
terminal necessary.
Sky blue (Sb) +
Up
Light green (Lg) -

15. Remove the special service tools, and


then install the manual valve and circlip.
9
Manual valve:
3 N·m (0.3 kgf·m, 2.2 ft·lb)
T.
R.

63P3F11 7-30
BRKT
Bracket unit
3. Remove the lead holder 1 and rubber 7. Remove the screw, disconnect the PTT
spacers 2 from the stator, and then slide motor lead (light green) 5, and then
them away from the stator. remove the brushes 6.

4. Remove the stator 3.

NOTE:
Place a clean cloth over the end of the arma-
ture shaft, hold it with a pair of pliers, and
then carefully slide the stator off of the arma-
ture.

CAUTION:
5. Remove the armature from the PTT • Do not pull the PTT motor leads out
motor base. from the stator.
• Do not touch the bimetal a, otherwise
CAUTION:
the operation of the circuit breaker can
Do not allow grease or oil to contact the be affected.
commutator.

Checking the power trim and tilt


6. Disconnect the PTT motor lead (sky
motor
blue) 4.
1. Measure the length of the brushes.
Replace if out of specification.

S60X7240

NOTE:
Hold the brush with a screwdriver as shown,
and then disconnect the PTT motor lead (sky Brush length limit a:
blue). 4.8 mm (0.19 in)

7-31 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
2. Check the brush and circuit breaker for
continuity. Replace if there is no continu-
ity.

1
2
CAUTION:
Do not touch the bimetal b, otherwise the
operation of the circuit breaker can be
3
affected.

3. Measure the commutator diameter.


Replace if out of specification.
Armature continuity

Commutator segments d Continuity


4
Segment d –
Armature core e
Segment d –
Armature shaft f
No continuity

No continuity
5
5. Check the base for cracks or damage.
Replace if necessary.

6. Check the bearing and oil seal for dam-


6
age or wear. Replace if necessary.
Commutator diameter limit c:
21.0 mm (0.83 in)

4. Check the armature for continuity.


7
Replace if out of specifications.

8
S60X7300

NOTE:
If the bearing and oil seal are removed,
always replace them with new ones.
9
63P3F11 7-32
BRKT
Bracket unit
Assembling the power trim and tilt Removing the reservoir
motor 1. Hold the power trim and tilt unit in a vise
1. Connect the PTT motor leads 1, and using aluminum plates a on both sides.
then tighten the screws 2.

2
S60X7310
CAUTION:
2. Push the brushes 3 into the brush Do not use rags or paper to clean the
holder, and then install the armature 4. hydraulic system components. Small
pieces of fibers remaining on them can
cause the system to malfunction.

NOTE:
Place a container under the power trim and
tilt unit to catch the fluid.

2. Remove the reservoir and O-rings.

3. Install the stator onto the base.

S60X7400

CAUTION:
• Make sure that the trim and tilt rams are
NOTE: fully extended when removing the reser-
Place a clean cloth over the end of the arma- voir, otherwise fluid can spurt out from
ture shaft, hold it with a pair of pliers, and the unit due to internal pressure.
then carefully slide the stator over the arma- • Do not push the tilt and trim rams down
ture. while the power trim and tilt motor is
removed from the power trim and tilt
unit, otherwise fluid can spurt out.

7-33 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
3. Drain the fluid from the reservoir and
check it for damage. Replace if neces-
sary.

4. Check the reservoir cap and O-ring for


damage. Replace if necessary. 1
Disassembling the gear pump

2
housing
1. Remove the gear pump housing.

3
S60X7430

NOTE:
Make sure that the shuttle pistons and balls
are removed, since they tend to stick to the
4
gear pump cover.

NOTE:
S60X7410

Make sure that the O-rings, valve pin, and


4. Remove the up-relief valve assembly. 5
valve seat assembly are removed.

2. Remove the filters, down-relief valve,


and O-ring from the gear pump housing.
6
7
S60X7420
S60X7440

8
NOTE:
Remove the back filter using compressed air,
being careful not to blow the filter out
abruptly.
9
3. Remove the gear pump cover and drive
gears.

63P3F11 7-34
BRKT
Bracket unit
5. Remove the main valves. Checking the gear pump
1. Clean all the valves, pistons, and balls,
and then check them for damage or
wear. Check the filters for damage or
clogs. Replace if necessary.

2. Check the drive gears for damage or


wear. Replace the gear pump assembly
if necessary.

a
b S60X7450

WARNING
Never look into the pump housing open-
ing while removing the main valves
because the main valves and power trim
and tilt fluid can be forcefully expelled
out.

NOTE:
To remove the main valves, cover the pump
housing with a clean cloth, and then blow
S63P7010
compressed air through holes a and b
while holding the cloth down.
Assembling the gear pump housing

6. Remove the manual valve. CAUTION:


Install the components and parts in their
original direction and positions.

1. Install a new O-ring 1, the up-relief valve


seat 2, ball 3, absorber valve pin 4,
and spring 5 into the gear pump hous-
ing.

S60X7460

7-35 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
2. Install new O-rings 6 onto the main 5. Install the gear pump cover B into the
valves 7, and then install the main gear pump housing, and then tighten the
valves into the gear pump housing. bolts.

B
1
2
S60X7520

3. Install the drive gears 8 into the gear


pump housing.
6. Check that the gear pump turns
smoothly, and then tighten the gear
pump cover bolts to the specified torque.
3
8
Gear pump cover bolt:
6 N·m (0.6 kgf·m, 4.4 ft·lb)
4
T.
R.

7. Install a new O-ring onto the down-relief


valve.

S60X7500
8. Install the filter, down-relief valve, and fil-
ter into the gear pump housing. 5
4. Install the balls 9, shuttle pistons 0, and
balls A into the gear pump cover.

6
S60X7530 7
9. Install a new O-ring onto the manual

8
valve.

10. Install the manual valve and circlip into


the gear pump housing.

Manual valve:
NOTE: 3 N·m (0.3 kgf·m, 2.2 ft·lb)
9
T.
R.

Apply grease to the balls and shuttle pistons


to prevent them from falling out of the gear
pump cover.

63P3F11 7-36
BRKT
Bracket unit
Disassembling the tilt cylinder and 6. Cover the tilt cylinder opening with a
trim cylinder clean cloth 1, and then blow com-
1. Loosen the tilt cylinder end screw, and pressed air through the hole a to
then remove the tilt piston assembly. remove the free piston 2.

S63P7020

CAUTION:
Make sure that the trim and tilt rams are
fully extended before removing the tilt cyl-
inder end screw.

Trim and tilt wrench:


New: 90890-06587
Current: 90890-06548 WARNING
Never look into the tilt cylinder opening
2. Drain the fluid. while removing the free piston because
the free piston and power trim and tilt
3. Loosen the trim cylinder end screws, and fluid can be forcefully expelled out.
then remove the trim piston assemblies.

7. Loosen the trim cylinder end screws, and


then remove the trim piston assemblies.

S63P7030

Trim and tilt wrench:


New: 90890-06587
Current: 90890-06548

4. Drain the fluid.

5. Install the trim piston assemblies, and


then tighten the trim cylinder end screws
finger tight.

7-37 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
Checking the tilt cylinder and trim 4. Check the tilt ram for bends or excessive
cylinder corrosion. Polish with 400- to 600-grit
1. Disassemble the tilt piston assembly. sandpaper if there is light rust or replace

1
if necessary.

2
5. Check the trim pistons for scratches.
Replace if necessary.
3
6. Check the trim rams for bends or exces-

S60X7570
sive corrosion. Polish with 400- to 600-
grit sandpaper if there is light rust or
replace if necessary.
4
2. Check the tilt piston and free piston for
scratches. Replace if necessary.
5
6
7. Check the inner walls of the trim and tilt

3. Blow the tilt piston absorber valve with


compressed air to remove any foreign
cylinders for scratches. Replace if neces-
sary. 7
material. Check the valve for wear and
the spring for deterioration. Replace if
necessary.
8
9
63P3F11 7-38
BRKT
Bracket unit
Assembling the tilt piston and trim
pistons
1. Install the new dust seal 1 and new O-
rings 2 and 3 onto the tilt cylinder end
screw.

Tilt piston nut:


96 N·m (9.6 kgf·m, 70.8 ft·lb)

T.
R.
6. Install a new backup ring E and a new
O-ring F onto the free piston D.

2. Install the tilt cylinder end screw 4 onto


the tilt ram 5.

7. Install a new oil seal G, a new dust seal


H, and a new O-ring I onto each trim
cylinder end screw.

8. Install the backup ring J and a new O-


ring K onto each trim piston.
3. Install new O-rings 6 and 7 onto the tilt
piston 8. A H
G
4. Install the ball 9, valve 0, and spring A,
in this order.
H I
5. Install the tilt piston assembly and
J
washer B onto the tilt ram 5, and then
tighten the tilt piston nut C to the speci- G K
fied torque.

J
K
S63P7360

7-39 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
Assembling the power trim and tilt 3. Fill the trim cylinders with the recom-
unit mended fluid to the correct level through
1. Fill the tilt cylinder with the specified holes b and c, and d as shown.
amount of the recommended fluid
through the hole a.
1
2
Recommended power trim and tilt
3
fluid:
ATF Dexron II
Fluid quantity:
30 cm3 (1.0 US oz, 1.1 Imp oz) 4
2. Push the free piston 1 into the tilt cylin- Recommended power trim and tilt
der until it bottoms out. fluid:
ATF Dexron II
5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11 7-40
BRKT
Bracket unit
4. Install the trim piston assemblies into the
trim cylinders, and then tighten the trim
cylinder end screws to the specified
torque.

S60X7730

Gear pump housing mounting bolt:


8 N·m (0.8 kgf·m, 5.9 ft·lb)

T.
R.
S63P7040

7. Install the O-ring into the reservoir cap.


CAUTION:
• Make sure that the trim rams are fully 8. Install the reservoir and O-ring onto the
extended when installing them. gear pump housing.
• Once installed, never push the trim rams
down, otherwise fluid can spurt out.

Trim and tilt wrench:


New: 90890-06587
Current: 90890-06548

Trim cylinder end screw: S60X7400


78 N·m (7.8 kgf·m, 57.5 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Reservoir mounting bolt:


5. Install new O-rings, the valve pin, and 5 N·m (0.5 kgf·m, 3.7 ft·lb)
T.
R.

valve seat assembly onto the tilt cylinder.


9. Fill the tilt cylinder with the recommended
fluid to the correct level through the hole
e as shown.

S60X7720

NOTE:
Refer to the illustration for valve pin and
valve seat assembly installation.
Recommended power trim and tilt
6. Install the gear pump housing. fluid:
ATF Dexron II

7-41 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit
10. Install the tilt piston assembly into the tilt 12. Fill the gear pump housing with the rec-
cylinder, and then tighten the tilt cylinder ommended fluid to the correct level as
end screw to the specified torque. shown.

1
2
Recommended power trim and tilt
fluid:
ATF Dexron II
3
13. Remove all of the air bubble using a
syringe or suitable tool.

NOTE:
4
S63P7060 Turn the joint with a screwdriver to bleed the
gear pump.
CAUTION:
• Make sure that the tilt ram is fully
extended when installing it.
14. Install a new O-ring 4 and the power
trim and tilt motor 5, and then tighten the
5
• Once installed, never push the tilt ram
bolts 6 to the specified torque.
down, otherwise fluid can spurt out.

Trim and tilt wrench:


6
New: 90890-06587

7
Current: 90890-06548

Tilt cylinder end screw:


130 N·m (13.0 kgf·m, 96.0 ft·lb)
T.
R.

11. Install the joint 2 and gear pump filter 3


into the gear pump housing.
NOTE:
Align the armature shaft with the recess in
the joint.
8
PTT motor mounting bolt:
5 N·m (0.5 kgf·m, 3.7 ft·lb) 9
T.
R.

63P3F11 7-42
BRKT
Bracket unit
15. Remove the reservoir cap, and then
check the fluid level in the reservoir. NOTE:
If the fluid is at the correct level, the fluid
NOTE: should overflow out of the filler hole when the
If the fluid is at the correct level, the fluid reservoir cap is removed.
should overflow out of the filler hole when the
reservoir cap is removed.
4. If necessary, add sufficient fluid of the
recommended type until it overflows out
16. If necessary, add sufficient fluid of the of the filler hole.
recommended type until it overflows out
of the filler hole. Recommended power trim and tilt
fluid:
Recommended power trim and tilt ATF Dexron II
fluid:
ATF Dexron II 5. Install the reservoir cap, and then tighten
it to the specified torque.
17. Install the reservoir cap, and then tighten
it to the specified torque. Reservoir cap:
0.7 N·m (0.07 kgf·m, 0.5 ft·lb)
T.
R.

Reservoir cap:
0.7 N·m (0.07 kgf·m, 0.5 ft·lb)
T.

6. Connect the PTT motor leads to the bat-


R.

tery terminals to fully retract the trim and


18. Bleed the power trim and tilt unit. tilt rams.

19. Check the hydraulic pressure of the


power trim and tilt unit.

Bleeding the power trim and tilt unit


1. Tighten the manual valve 1 by turning it
clockwise.

Battery
Rams PTT motor lead
terminal
Light green (Lg) +
Down
Sky blue (Sb) -

7. Reverse the PTT motor leads between


the battery terminals to fully extend the
trim and tilt rams.

2. Place the power trim and tilt unit in an


upright position.

3. Remove the reservoir cap, and then


check the fluid level in the reservoir.

7-43 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit

CAUTION:
After tilting the outboard motor up, be

1
sure to support it with the tilt stop lever.

2. Install the collars.

3. Lift the power trim and tilt unit up, and

Rams PTT motor lead


Battery
terminal
then install the upper mounting shaft.

4. Install the circlip.


2
5. Install the lower mounting shaft, and then
+

3
Sky blue (Sb)
Up tighten the bolts.
Light green (Lg) -
6. Install the plastic ties, route the PTT
NOTE: motor leads through the hole, and then
• Repeat this procedure so that the rams go install the plastic ties.
up and down four or five times (be sure to
wait a few seconds before switching the
leads).
• If the rams do not move up and down eas-
7. Connect the ground lead to the bottom of
the power trim and tilt unit, and then
tighten the bolt.
4
ily, push and pull on the rams to assist
operation.

8. Check the fluid level when the tilt ram is


A

A
5
fully extended. Add sufficient fluid if nec-
essary.

Installing the power trim and tilt unit


1. Fully tilt the outboard motor up, and then
6
support it with the tilt stop lever 1.

LT
242
A

A A

S60X7130
7
1

8
S60X7820
9
63P3F11 7-44
BRKT
Bracket unit
Bleeding the power trim and tilt unit
(built-in) WARNING
1. Fully turn the manual valve counterclock- After tilting up the outboard motor, be
wise. sure to support it with the tilt stop lever.
Otherwise, the outboard motor could sud-
denly lower if the power trim and tilt unit
should lose fluid pressure.

7. Remove the reservoir cap 2, and then


check the fluid level in the reservoir.

2. Fully tilt the outboard motor up, and then


release it to let it lower by its own weight
four to five times.

3. Tighten the manual valve by turning it 2


S60X3030
clockwise.
NOTE:
4. Let the fluid settle for 5 minutes.
If the fluid is at the correct level, the fluid
5. Push and hold the power trim and tilt should overflow out of the filler hole when the
switch in the up position to check that the reservoir cap is removed.
outboard motor is fully tilted up.
8. If necessary, add sufficient fluid of the
6. Support the outboard motor with the tilt
recommended type to the correct level.
stop lever 1.
Recommended power trim and tilt
1 fluid:
ATF Dexron II

9. Install the reservoir cap, and then tighten


it to the specified torque.

Reservoir cap:
0.7 N·m (0.07 kgf·m, 0.5 ft·lb)
T.
R.

NOTE:
Repeat this procedure until the fluid remains
S60X3020 at the correct level.

7-45 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt unit / Power trim and tilt electrical system
Power trim and tilt electrical system 7

2
I

3
H
2 3 4
R R R
17
R

B
4
B

1
E 1DCBA098765432 G

R
F

5
R

2
R R R

6
B
3
Lg Sb

Sb Lg

Lg Sb Lg
4
5
9
Sb R Lg
UP
FREE R
Sb Lg
DOWN
Lg Sb Lg

Lg R
R Sb Sb
Sb Lg Lg È
R

6
Lg
B
Sb
B

Lg
Sb 7

7
B

B
B
8
É P

8
P Gy Gy

S63P7270

1 Fuse holder È To remote control box/switch B : Black


2

9
Fuse (20 A) panel Gy : Gray
3 Fuse (50 A) É To trim meter Lg : Light green
4 Battery P : Pink
5 Power trim and tilt relay R : Red
6 Power trim and tilt motor Sb : Sky blue
7 Diode
8 Trim sensor
9 Power trim and tilt switch

63P3F11 7-46
BRKT
Bracket unit
Checking the fuse 3. Connect the light green (Lg) lead to the
1. Check the fuse for continuity. Replace if positive battery terminal and the black
there is no continuity. (B) lead to the negative battery terminal
as shown.

4. Check for continuity between terminals


2 and 3. Replace if there is no continu-
ity.

S69J7525

Checking the power trim and tilt


relay
1. Check the power trim and tilt relay for
continuity. Replace if out of specification.
5. Connect the digital circuit tester between
power trim and tilt relay terminals 1 and
3.

6. Connect the sky blue (Sb) lead to the


positive battery terminal and the black
(B) lead to the negative battery terminal
as shown.

7. Check for continuity between terminals


NOTE: 1 and 3. Replace if there is no continu-
Be sure to set the measurement range a ity.
shown in the illustration when checking for
continuity.

Power trim and tilt relay continuity

Sky blue (Sb) – Black (B)


Continuity
Light green (Lg) – Black (B)
Terminal 1 – Terminal 4
Continuity
Terminal 2 – Terminal 4
Terminal 1 – Terminal 3 Checking the power trim and tilt
No continuity
Terminal 2 – Terminal 3 switch
1. Check the power trim and tilt switch for
2. Connect the digital circuit tester between continuity. Replace if out of specification.
power trim and tilt relay terminals 2 and
3.

7-47 63P3F11
Power trim and tilt electrical system

1
Lead color
2
Switch
position
Up
Free
Sky blue
(Sb)
Red (R)
Light green
(Lg)
3
4
Down

Checking the trim sensor


1. Measure the trim sensor resistance.
Replace if out of specification.

5
6
NOTE:
Turn the lever 1 and measure the resistance
as it gradually changes.
7
Trim sensor resistance:
Pink (P) – Black (B)
238.8–378.8 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F) a
9–11 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F) b
8
9
63P3F11 7-48
BRKT
Bracket unit

— MEMO —

7-49 63P3F11
– +
ELEC

Electrical systems

Special service tools .....................................................................................8-1

Checking the electrical components............................................................ 8-2


Measuring the peak voltage ...................................................................... 8-2
1
Measuring the lower resistance.................................................................8-2

Electrical components................................................................................... 8-3


Port view.................................................................................................... 8-3
Junction box assembly ..............................................................................8-4
2
Aft view ...................................................................................................... 8-5

3
Top view .................................................................................................... 8-6
Wiring harness........................................................................................... 8-7

Ignition and ignition control system ............................................................ 8-9


Checking the ignition spark gap ..............................................................8-11

4
Checking the spark plug wires.................................................................8-11
Checking the ignition coils ....................................................................... 8-11
Checking the ECM...................................................................................8-12
Checking the pulser coil ..........................................................................8-12
Checking the throttle position sensor ......................................................8-13
Checking the intake air temperature sensor............................................8-13
Checking the engine temperature sensor................................................ 8-13
Checking the thermoswitch ..................................................................... 8-14
Checking the shift cut switch ................................................................... 8-14
Checking the neutral switch..................................................................... 8-14
5
Fuel control system .....................................................................................8-15
Checking the injectors ............................................................................. 8-17
Checking the main relay ..........................................................................8-17
6
Checking the electric fuel pump ..............................................................8-17

Starting system ............................................................................................ 8-18


Checking the fuses .................................................................................. 8-19
Checking the starter relay........................................................................8-19
7
Starter motor ................................................................................................8-20
Removing the starter motor pinion .......................................................... 8-22
Checking the starter motor pinion............................................................ 8-22
Checking the armature ............................................................................8-22
8
Checking the brushes.............................................................................. 8-23

9
Checking the magnet switch.................................................................... 8-23
Checking the starter motor operation ......................................................8-23

Charging system .......................................................................................... 8-24


Checking the stator coil ...........................................................................8-25
Checking the Rectifier Regulator............................................................. 8-25

63P3F11
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Special service tools 8

Ignition tester Test harness (3 pins)


90890-06754 90890-06793

Digital circuit tester Test harness (3 pins)


90890-03174 90890-06847

Peak voltage adapter B Test harness (3 pins)


90890-03172 90890-06846

Test harness (2 pins)


90890-06792

Test harness (3 pins)


90890-06791

8-1 63P3F11
Special service tools / Checking the electrical components
Checking the electrical Measuring the lower resistance
components 8
When measuring a resistance of 10 Ω or less
Measuring the peak voltage with the digital circuit tester, the correct mea-

1
surement cannot be obtained due to the
NOTE: internal resistance of the tester. To obtain the
Before troubleshooting the peak voltage, correct value, subtract the internal resistance
check that all electrical connections are tight from the displayed measurement.
and free from corrosion, and that the battery
NOTE:
is fully charged to 12 V.

The condition of the ignition system can be


determined by measuring the peak voltage.
To obtain the internal resistance of the digital
circuit tester, connect both of its probes and
check the display.
2
Cranking speed is effected by many factors,
such as fouled or weak spark plugs, or a
weak battery. If one of these factors is
present, the peak voltage will be lower than
specification. In addition, if the peak voltage
Correct value =
displayed measurement – internal
resistance
3
is lower than specification the engine will not
operate properly.
4
DC V

5
WARNING
When checking the peak voltage, do not
S69J8020

6
touch any of the connections of the digital
tester leads.

NOTE:
7
• Use the peak voltage adapter with the digi-

8
tal circuit tester.
• When measuring the peak voltage, set the
selector on the digital circuit tester to the
DC voltage mode.
• Connect the positive pin on the peak volt-
age adapter to the positive terminal of the
digital circuit tester.
9
63P3F11 8-2
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Electrical components 8

Port view

2 3 4

S63P8010

1 ECM
2 Starter motor
3 Rectifier Regulator
4 Thermoswitch
5 Ignition coil
6 Oil pressure sensor
7 Junction box
8 Fuse holder

8-3 63P3F11
Electrical components
Junction box assembly

1
1
2
2
9
3
8 4
5
7
6

5
6
4 7
3

S63P8020 8
1 ECM
2

9
Power trim and tilt relay
3 Starter relay
4 Diode
5 Fuse (30 A)
6 Main relay
7 Fuse (20 A)
8 Fuse (50 A)
9 Intake air temperature sensor

63P3F11 8-4
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Aft view

1
2

A A

A-A
4
5

S63P8030

1 Intake air pressure sensor


2 Throttle position sensor
3 Fuel injector
4 Shift cut switch
5 Neutral switch
6 Ignition coil
7 Thermoswitch
8 Spark plug

8-5 63P3F11
Electrical components
Top view

1
1
2
8 2

7
6

3
9 3 4
0
5
A
6
5
7
4

S63P8040 8
1 Fuel injector A Power trim and tilt switch
2

9
Ignition coil
3 Starter motor
4 Stator coil
5 Engine temperature sensor
6 Throttle position sensor
7 Idle speed control
8 Intake air pressure sensor
9 Shift cut switch
0 Neutral switch

63P3F11 8-6
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Wiring harness

1 : G 10 : O 19 : G 28 : Y 37 : P
: : _ : : :
2 Y/G 11 20 G/R 29 P/W 38 Pu/Y
3 : P 12 : O 21 : G/Y 30 : R/Y 39 : Pu/B
: : _ : : :
4 W 13 22 B/O 31 L/G 40 Pu/R
: _ : : : : _
5 14 W/R 23 P/B 32 B 41
6 : _
15 : W/B
_
24 : P/W
_
33 : P/G 42 : B R
B
7 : B/Y 16 : 25 : 34 : P 43 : Pu/G G
Y
8 : B 17 : L 26 : W/B 35 : B/Y 44 : B/W Lg

: : : : _ W
9 L/Y 18 G/B 27 L/W 36

L/W
A P

Br
Sb
B

2 7
P/B P/W

21
35
0 D E F
Sb Lg O B L/G L/Y
46
7 9
8
9 B B
R
0
A 8 P

B
5 5 B
R/Y W/B

C
D 6 Lg
4 B/Y
B C B B

34
B/Y B B

Sb
B B
R B B B B
L/W L/W Br

B Sb Lg

R/Y G/R P/G O


G/B
E W/R W/B
G/Y

1 K G R/Y
B J
B
I Pu/G

1 : Y/G 6 : R/Y 11 : R/Y P/W O Pu/R


2 : R 7 : R/Y 12 : R/Y Pu/Y R/Y
3 : R 8 : R/Y 13 : R/Y
L R/Y
G
4
5
:
:
R
R/Y
9
10
:
:
R/Y
R/Y
14
15
:
:
R/Y
R B
G Pu/B
R/Y
G
P B M R/Y
L
G
R/Y

N R/Y
R/Y H
B/O

N
B/W
S63P8190

Connect to: D Throttle position sensor


1 Fuse holder E Neutral switch
2 Fuse holder F Shift cut switch
3 Diagnostic flash indicator G Fuel injector
4 Starter relay H Electric fuel pump
5 Ground I Intake air pressure sensor
6 Power trim and tilt relay J Idle speed control
7 ECM K Pulser coil
8 Intake air temperature sensor L Oil pressure sensor
9 Personal computer for diagnosis M Thermoswitch
0 Power trim and tilt switch N Ignition coil
A Warning indicator
B Remote control
C Engine temperature sensor

8-7 63P3F11
Electrical components

1 : G 10 : O 19 : G 28 : Y 37 : P
_

1
2 : Y/G 11 : 20 : G/R 29 : P/W 38 : Pu/Y
3 : P 12 : O 21 : G/Y 30 : R/Y 39 : Pu/B
: : _ : : :
4 W 13 22 B/O 31 L/G 40 Pu/R
: _ : : : : _
5 14 W/R 23 P/B 32 B 41
6 : _
15 : W/B
_
24 : P/W
_
33 : P/G 42 : B R
B
7 : B/Y 16 : 25 : 34 : P 43 : Pu/G G
Y
8 : B 17 : L 26 : W/B 35 : B/Y 44 : B/W Lg

: : : : _ W
9 L/Y 18 G/B 27 L/W 36

2
P Sb
L/W Br B

2 7
P/B P/W

21
35
0 D E F
Sb Lg O B L/G L/Y
46
9

3
7
8
9 B B
R
0
A 8 P

B
5 5 B
R/Y W/B

C
D 6 Lg
4 B/Y
B C B B

34
B/Y B B

4
Sb
B B
R B B B B
L/W L/W Br

B Sb Lg

5
R/Y G/R P/G O
G/B
E W/R W/B
G/Y

1 K G R/Y
B J
B
I Pu/G

1 : Y/G 6 : R/Y 11 : R/Y P/W O Pu/R


2 : R 7 : R/Y 12 : R/Y Pu/Y R/Y
3 : R 8 : R/Y 13 : R/Y
L G

6
R/Y
4
5
:
:
R
R/Y
9
10
:
:
R/Y
R/Y
14
15
:
:
R/Y
R B
G Pu/B
R/Y
G
P B M R/Y
L
G
R/Y

7
N R/Y
R/Y H
B/O

N
B/W
S63P8190

B : Black B/Y : Black/yellow R/Y : Red/yellow


Br
G
Gy
L
: Brown
: Green
: Gray
: Blue
G/B
G/R
G/Y
L/G
: Green/black
: Green/red
: Green/yellow
: Blue/green
W/B
W/R
Y/G
: White/black
: White/red
: Yellow/green
8
Lg : Light green L/W : Blue/white
O
P
R
Sb
W
: Orange
: Pink
: Red
: Sky blue
: White
L/Y
P/B
P/G
P/W
Pu/B
: Blue/yellow
: Pink/black
: Pink/green
: Pink/white
: Purple/black
9
Y : Yellow Pu/G : Purple/green
B/O : Black/orange Pu/R : Purple/red
B/W : Black/white Pu/Y : Purple/yellow

63P3F11 8-8
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Ignition and ignition control system 8

B
P 3 W/R B B

W/B
B
O
R/Y B/O R/Y B/W W/B W/R

4
B W/R
B
R/Y P/W
R/Y B

5
B/O B/W
R R 2 3
Y/G P
7 8 9 10
B/Y B L/Y O
5 #2/3 #1/4
B/W B/W 7 12 14 15 18 19 20
O W/R W/B G/B G G/R
21 22 24 28 29 30 6
B/W R B/W R G/Y B/O P/W Y P/W R/Y

31 32 33 34 35 37
2 2 L/G B P/G P B/Y P
G
1 4 2 3 42 44
B B/W
B

1 1 1 1
B/Y B/Y
G G

G
B/Y
B/Y
E
B D B B/Y

8 B R R 1G/R
G/Y 4 R/Y5

6
R/Y R/Y B/Y 2 R/Y
P Y 5
Y/G 4
3
F
3G/B 2
1
B G6

R
9 B
E
È B B
1
D
C
B
A
B B
0
9
8 A
7
6
5 0
4 A
3
2
B B P
G I

F H G
1 5 6 7 O
Y/G R/Y R/Y R/Y

12 17 19
R
R/Y R R H
R
P/G B

B B
B B
L/Y
B I
L/Y

B B

L/G
B J
C B
L/G

S63P8200

1 Spark plug A Fuse (20 A) È To remote control box/switch


2 Ignition coil B Fuse (50 A) panel
3 Thermoswitch C Battery
4 Oil pressure sensor D Rectifier Regulator
5 Pulser coil E Engine temperature sensor
6 Stator coil F Idle speed control
7 ECM G Throttle position sensor
8 Intake air temperature sensor H Intake air pressure sensor
9 Fuse holder I Shift cut switch
0 Main relay J Neutral switch

8-9 63P3F11
Ignition and ignition control system
8

B
3

1
P W/R B B

W/B
B
O
R/Y B/O R/Y B/W W/B W/R

4
B W/R
B
R/Y P/W
R/Y B

5
B/O

2
B/W
R R 2 3
Y/G P
7 8 9 10
B/Y B L/Y O
5 #2/3 #1/4
B/W B/W 7 12 14 15 18 19 20
O W/R W/B G/B G G/R
21 22 24 28 29 30 6
B/W R B/W R G/Y B/O P/W Y P/W R/Y

31 32 33 34 35 37
2 2 L/G B P/G P B/Y P
G
1 4 2 3 42 44
B B/W
B

1 1 1 1
G

G
G
B/Y B/Y

B/Y
B/Y
E
3
B D B B/Y

4
B

8 B R R 1G/R
G/Y 4 R/Y5

6
R/Y R/Y B/Y 2 R/Y
P Y 5
Y/G 4
3
F
3G/B 2
1
B G6

5
R
9 B
E
È B B
1
D
C
B
A
B B
0
9
8 A
7
6

6
5 0
4 A
3
2
B B P
G I

F H G
1 5 6 7 O
Y/G R/Y R/Y R/Y

12 17 19
R
H

7
R/Y R R

R
P/G B

B B
B B
L/Y
B I
L/Y

B B

C B
L/G
L/G
B

S63P8200
J

8
B : Black G/R : Green/red

9
G : Green G/Y : Green/yellow
O : Orange L/G : Blue/green
P : Pink L/Y : Blue/yellow
R : Red P/G : Pink/green
Y : Yellow P/W : Pink/white
B/O : Black/orange R/Y : Red/yellow
B/W : Black/white W/B : White/black
B/Y : Black/yellow W/R : White/red
G/B : Green/black Y/G : Yellow/green

63P3F11 8-10
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Checking the ignition spark gap Checking the spark plug wires
1. Remove the spark plug wire cover. 1. Remove the spark plug wires from the
spark plugs.
2. Disconnect the spark plug caps from the
spark plugs. 2. Remove the spark plug wires from the
ignition coil.
3. Connect a spark plug cap to the special
service tool. 3. Measure the spark plug wire resistance.
Replace if out of specification.

S63P8070
S60C8100

Ignition tester: 90890-06754


Spark plug wire resistance:
#1: 4.6–10.9 kΩ
4. Crank the engine and observe the spark #2: 3.3–8.0 kΩ
through the discharge window of the #3: 3.8–9.3 kΩ
spark gap tester. Check the ignition sys- #4: 4.2–10.0 kΩ
tem if the spark is weak.
Checking the ignition coils
1. Remove the spark plug wires from the
ignition coil.

2. Disconnect the ignition coil coupler.

3. Measure the ignition coil resistance.


Replace if out of specification.

S63P8090

WARNING
• Do not touch any of the connections of
the spark gap tester leads.
• Do not let sparks leak out of the
removed spark plug caps.
• Keep flammable gas or liquids away,
S63P8100
since this test can produce sparks.

NOTE:
The ignition spark gap can also be checked
using the “Stationary test” of the Yamaha
Diagnostic System.

8-11 63P3F11
Ignition and ignition control system
3. Measure the pulser coil output peak volt-
Ignition coil resistance: age. Replace the pulser coil if below
Primary coil: specification.
Red (R) – Black/white (B/W)
1.53–2.07 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F)
Secondary coil:
12.50–16.91 kΩ at 20 °C (68 °F)
1
Checking the ECM
1. Disconnect a ignition coil coupler.

2. Connect the test harness (2 pins) to the


2
S63P8120
ignition coil.

3. Measure the ECM output peak voltage. If


below specification, measure the pulser
coil output peak voltage. Replace the
Digital circuit tester: 90890-03174
Peak voltage adapter B:
90890-03172
3
ECM if the output peak voltage of the Test harness (3 pins): 90890-06791
pulser coil is above specification.
Pulser coil output peak voltage:
White/red (W/R) – Black (B)
White/black (W/B) – Black (B)
4
5
Unloaded Loaded
r/min
Cranking 1,500 3,500
DC V 3.5 3.6 23.9 49.7

6
S63P8110 Pulser coil resistance
(use as reference):
Digital circuit tester: 90890-03174 459–561 Ω
Peak voltage adapter B:
90890-03172
Test harness (2 pins): 90890-06792

ECM output peak voltage:


7
Black/orange (B/O) – Ground

8
Black/white (B/W) – Ground
Loaded
r/min
Cranking 1,500 3,500
DC V 260 260 270

Checking the pulser coil


1. Remove the flywheel magnet cover and
disconnect the pulser coil coupler.
9
2. Connect the test harness (3 pins) to the
pulser coil.

63P3F11 8-12
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Checking the throttle position Checking the intake air temperature
sensor sensor
1. Remove the flywheel magnet cover. 1. Place the intake air temperature sensor
in a container of water and slowly heat
2. Connect the test harness (3 pins) to the the water.
throttle position sensor.

3. Turn the engine start switch to ON.

4. Measure the throttle position sensor


input voltage. Check the wiring harness
connection or replace the ECM if out of
specification.

5. Measure the throttle position sensor out- S69J8230


put voltage. Adjust the throttle position
sensor if out of specification. 2. Measure the intake air temperature sen-
sor resistance. Replace if out of specifi-
cation.

Intake air temperature sensor


resistance:
at 20 °C (68 °F): 2.20–2.70 kΩ

Checking the engine temperature


S63P8130
sensor
1. Place the engine temperature sensor in a
NOTE: container of water and slowly heat the
To measure the output voltage, connect the water.
positive tester probe to the pink wire of the
test harness and the negative tester probe to
the orange wire of the test harness.

Digital circuit tester: 90890-03174


Test harness (3 pins): 90890-06793

Throttle position sensor input S69J8240


voltage:
Orange (O) – Black (B)
2. Measure the engine temperature sensor
5V
resistance. Replace if out of specifica-
Throttle position sensor output
tion.
voltage:
Pink (P) – Black (B) Engine temperature sensor
0.70 ± 0.02 V resistance:
Black/yellow (B/Y) –
Black/yellow (B/Y)
at 20 °C (68 °F): 54.2–69.0 kΩ
at 100 °C (212 °F): 3.12–3.48 kΩ

8-13 63P3F11
Ignition and ignition control system
Checking the thermoswitch
1. Place the thermoswitches in a container Lead color
Switch
of water and slowly heat the water. Blue/yellow
position Black (B)
(L/Y)
Free a
Push b
1
Checking the neutral switch
1. Check the neutral switch for continuity.
Replace if there is no continuity. 2
S69J8250
a
2. Check the switch for continuity at the
specified temperatures. Replace if out of
specification.
b
3
Lead color
S69J8270
4
Switch
Blue/green

5
position Black (B)
(L/G)
Free a
Push b
a Temperature
b

6
Time
c No continuity
d Continuity

Thermoswitch continuity
temperature:
Pink (P) – Black (B)
e: 84–90 °C (183–194 °F)
f: 68–82 °C (154–180 °F)
7
Checking the shift cut switch
1. Check the shift cut switch for continuity.
Replace if there is no continuity. 8
a
b
9
S69J8270

63P3F11 8-14
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Fuel control system 8

W/R B B

W/B
B

W/B W/R

W/R
B

1 B/Y B/Y

1 #2/3 #1/4
B/Y
B/Y
9
B B/Y

2 3 7 8 10 R/Y5
1G/R G/Y 4
Y/G P B/Y B O
6
2 12 14 15 17 18 19 20 2 R/Y
5
O W/R W/B L G/B G G/R 4
3
0
21 28 30 2
3G/B
G/Y Y R/Y 1
32 33 34 35 38 39 40 G6
B P/G P B/Y Pw/Y Pw/B Pw/R
B
42 43 B
B Pw/G
B

B B

B P

B P Y
A
3 O

B
B/Y
B
B
R/Y
Y/G È P/G B

R/Y

R/Y R/Y
Pu/R C
#1
Pu/R

4 L R/Y
E
L L
1
D R/Y R/Y
C R/Y L
B
A
0
R/Y L
9 R/Y
8 6
7 R/Y
6 C
5 5 Pu/B
#2
4 Pu/B
3
2
7 R/Y
G
R/Y
F
Pu/Y C
#3
Pu/Y
R 1 5 8 9 10 D
Y/G R/Y R/Y R/Y R/Y
R/Y
R
11 12 13 17
R/Y
R/Y R/Y R/Y R
Pu/G
C
#4
Pu/G
B B

8
B

S63P8210

1 Pulser coil A Throttle position sensor


2 ECM B Intake air pressure sensor
3 Intake air temperature sensor C Fuel injector
4 Fuse holder D Electric fuel pump
5 Main relay
6 Fuse (20 A) È To remote control box/switch panel
7 Fuse (50 A)
8 Battery
9 Engine temperature sensor
0 Idle speed control

8-15 63P3F11
Fuel control system
8

W/R B B

W/B

1
B

W/B W/R

W/R
B

1 B/Y B/Y

1 #2/3 #1/4
B/Y
B/Y
9

2
B B/Y

2 3 7 8 10 R/Y5
1G/R G/Y 4
Y/G P B/Y B O
6
2 12 14 15 17 18 19 20 2 R/Y
5
O W/R W/B L G/B G G/R 4
3
0
21 28 30 2
3G/B
G/Y Y R/Y 1
32 33 34 35 38 39 40 G6
B P/G P B/Y Pw/Y Pw/B Pw/R
B

3
42 43 B
B Pw/G
B

B B

B P

B P Y
A
3

4
O

B
B/Y
B
B
R/Y
Y/G È P/G B

R/Y

R/Y R/Y
Pu/R C
#1

5
Pu/R

4 L R/Y
E
L L
1
D R/Y R/Y
C R/Y L
B
A
0
R/Y L
9 R/Y
8 6

6
7 R/Y
6 C
5 5 Pu/B
#2
4 Pu/B
3
2
7 R/Y
G
R/Y
F
Pu/Y C
#3
Pu/Y
R 1 5 8 9 10 D
Y/G R/Y R/Y R/Y R/Y

7
R/Y
R
11 12 13 17
R/Y
R/Y R/Y R/Y R
Pu/G
C
#4
Pu/G
B B

8
B

S63P8210 8
B : Black G/Y : Green/yellow

9
G : Green P/G : Pink/green
L : Blue Pu/B : Purple/black
O : Orange Pu/G : Purple/green
P : Pink Pu/R : Purple/red
R : Red Pu/Y : Purple/yellow
Y : Yellow R/Y : Red/yellow
B/Y : Black/yellow W/B : White/black
G/B : Green/black W/R : White/red
G/R : Green/red Y/G : Yellow/green

63P3F11 8-16
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Checking the injectors
1. Measure the resistance of the fuel injec-
tors. Replace if out of specification.
1

2
S60V8450

Digital circuit tester: 90890-03174


Checking the electric fuel pump
1. Turn the engine start switch to ON.
Fuel injector resistance 2. Listen for the operating sound of the
(use as reference): electric fuel pump 1. Check the fuel sys-
14.0–15.0 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F) tem if there is no sound.

NOTE:
Check the operation of the fuel injectors
using the “Stationary test” of the Yamaha
Diagnostic System.

Checking the main relay


1. Remove the fuse holder cover, and then
remove the fuse holder.

2. Connect the digital circuit tester leads to NOTE:


the main relay terminals 1 and 2. After the engine start switch is turned to ON,
the electric fuel pump will operate for 3 sec-
3. Connect the positive battery terminal to onds.
the main relay terminal 1.

4. Connect the negative battery terminal to


the main relay terminal 3.

5. Check for continuity between the main


relay terminals. Replace if there is no
continuity.

6. Check that there is no continuity between


the relay terminals after disconnecting a
battery terminal from the main relay ter-
minals 1 and 3. Replace if there is con-
tinuity.

8-17 63P3F11
Fuel control system / Starting system
Starting system 8

1
2
1 I

3 4
H
3 4
R R

15
R
17
R

B
7
B
2
3
E 1DCBA098765432 G F

R R

R R R

4
Br/W

5
R

Br
B

6
Br

R
B
È

7
Br B

S63P8220 8
1 Fuse holder B : Black
2

9
Fuse (30 A) Br : Brown
3 Fuse (20 A) R : Red
4 Fuse (50 A) Br/W : Brown/white
5 Starter relay
6 Starter motor
7 Battery

È To remote control box/switch panel

63P3F11 8-18
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Checking the fuses
1. Check the fuses for continuity. Replace if
there is no continuity.

S69J8340

Checking the starter relay


1. Connect the digital circuit tester leads to
the starter relay terminals.

2. Connect the positive battery terminal to


the brown (Br) lead.

3. Connect the negative battery terminal to


the black (B) lead.

4. Check for continuity between the starter


relay terminals. Replace if there is no
continuity.

5. Check that there is no continuity between


the starter relay terminals after discon-
necting a battery terminal from the brown
or black lead. Replace if there is continu-
ity.

Br

B
S60V8265

8-19 63P3F11
Starting system / Starter motor
Starter motor 8

15
2
3
4
5
1
16
6 2
7
17
8
9
27 28
3
18
10

4
19 19 26
20 11 29
19 19
21
30
22 31
23

24
12

13
5
14

No.
25

Part name Q’ty Remarks


S63P8050
6
1 Clip 1
2
3
4
5
Pinion stopper
Starter motor pinion
Spring
Bolt
1
1
1
2 M6 × 35 mm
7
6 Housing 1
7
8
9
10
Bearing
Clutch assembly
E-clip
Washer
1
1
1
1
Not reusable
8
11 Bracket 1
12
13
14
15
Pinion shaft
Planetary gear
Outer gear
Plate
1
3
1
1
9
16 Armature 1
17 Stator 1

63P3F11 8-20
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
8

1
2
3
15 4
5

16
6

7
17
8 27 28
18 9
19 10
19 26
20 11 29
19 19
21
30
22 31
23
12

13
24
14
25 S63P8050

No. Part name Q’ty Remarks


18 Brush assembly 1
19 Brush spring 4
20 Brush holder 1
21 Plate 1
22 Washer 1
23 Bracket 1
24 Screw 2 ø4 × 15 mm
25 Bolt 2 M6 × 120 mm
26 Rubber seal 1
27 Shift lever 1
28 Spring 1
29 Magnet switch assembly 1
30 Washer 1
31 Nut 1

8-21 63P3F11
Starter motor
Removing the starter motor pinion
1. Slide the pinion stopper 1 down as
shown, and then remove the clip 2.

1
2. Measure the commutator diameter.
2
Replace the armature if out of specifica-
tion.
NOTE:
Remove the clip with a thin screwdriver. 3
Checking the starter motor pinion
1. Check the teeth of the pinion for cracks
or wear. Replace if necessary. 4
Commutator diameter limit:
28.0 mm (1.10 in)
5
6
3. Measure the commutator undercut a.
Replace the armature if out of specifica-
tion.
2. Check for smooth operation. Replace if
necessary.

NOTE:
Turn the pinion counterclockwise to check
that it operates smoothly and turn it clockwise
7
to check that it locks in place.

Checking the armature


1. Check the commutator for dirt. Clean
8
with 600–grit sandpaper and com- Commutator undercut limit a:

9
pressed air if necessary. 0.2 mm (0.01 in)

63P3F11 8-22
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
4. Check the armature for continuity.
Replace if out of specifications. Brush continuity

Brush 1 – Brush 2 No continuity

Checking the magnet switch


1. Connect the tester leads between the
magnet switch terminals as shown.

2. Connect the positive battery lead to the


brown and white (Br/W) lead.

3. Connect the negative battery lead to the


Armature continuity starter motor body.

Commutator segments b Continuity


Br/W
Segment – Armature core c No continuity
Segment – Armature shaft d No continuity

Checking the brushes


1. Measure the brush length. Replace the
brush assembly if out of specification.
S69J8450

CAUTION:
Do not connect the battery for more than
one second, otherwise the magnet switch
can be damaged.

4. Check that there is continuity between


the magnet switch terminals. Replace if
there is no continuity.
Brush length limit a:
9.5 mm (0.37 in) 5. Check that there is no continuity after the
negative battery terminal is removed.
2. Check the brush holder assembly for Replace if there is continuity.
continuity. Replace if out of specifica-
tions. NOTE:
The starter motor pinion should be pushed
out while the magnet switch is on.

2 1
Checking the starter motor operation
1. Check the operation of the starter motor
after installing it onto the power unit.

S69J8440

8-23 63P3F11
Starter motor / Charging system
Charging system 8

1
#2/3 #1/4

G
G
G

G
G
G
2
B 2

E
1
D
C
B
A
0
3

16 17 18 19
R R R R
B
R R

3
9
8

4
7
6
5
4
3
2
4
G I
R
4 R
F H

R
R B

B
B

B
5
5 6

R R B

6
B

7
S63P8230 8
1 Stator coil B : Black
2

9
Rectifier Regulator G : Green
3 Fuse holder R : Red
4 Fuse (50 A)
5 Accessory battery
6 Battery

63P3F11 8-24
– +
ELEC
Electrical systems
Checking the stator coil 3. Measure the Rectifier Regulator output
1. Disconnect the stator coil coupler. peak voltage. If below specification, mea-
sure the stator coil output peak voltage.
2. Connect the test harness (3 pins) to the Replace the Rectifier Regulator if the out-
stator coil. put peak voltage of the stator coil is
above specification.
3. Measure the stator coil output peak volt-
age. Replace the stator coil assembly if
below specification.

S63P8170

Digital circuit tester: 90890-03174


S63P8160 Peak voltage adapter B:
90890-03172
Digital circuit tester: 90890-03174 Test harness (3 pins): 90890-06846
Peak voltage adapter B:
90890-03172
Test harness (3 pins): 90890-06847 Rectifier Regulator output peak
voltage:
Red (R) – Black (B)
Stator coil output peak voltage:
Unloaded
Green (G) – Green (G) r/min
1,500 3,500
Unloaded
r/min DC V 13.0 13.0
Cranking 1,500 3,500
DC V 12 50 110

Stator coil resistance


(use as reference):
Green (G) – Green (G)
0.20–0.30 Ω at 20 °C (68 °F)

Checking the Rectifier Regulator


1. Disconnect the Rectifier Regulator cou-
pler.

2. Connect the test harness (3 pins) to the


Rectifier Regulator.

8-25 63P3F11
TRBL
SHTG
Troubleshooting

Special service tools .....................................................................................9-1

Yamaha Diagnostic System ..........................................................................9-2


Introduction................................................................................................9-2
1
Power unit....................................................................................................... 9-5

Self-diagnosis...............................................................................................9-19
Diagnosing the electronic control system ................................................ 9-19
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting
Special service tools 9

Yamaha Diagnostic System


60V-85300-02

YAMAHA
DIAGNOSTIC
SYSTEM
INSTALLATION MANUAL

Yamaha Diagnostic System


60V-WS853-02

Diagnostic flash indicator B


90890-06865

9-1 63P3F11
Special service tools / Yamaha Diagnostic System
Yamaha Diagnostic System 9

Introduction
Features
The newly developed Yamaha Diagnostic System provides quicker detection and analysis of engine
malfunctions for quicker troubleshooting procedures than traditional methods.
By connecting your computer to the ECM (Electronic Control Module) of an outboard motor using
the communication cable, this software can be used to display sensor data and data stored in the
1
ECM on a computer’s monitor.
If this software is run on Microsoft Windows® 95, Windows 98, Windows Me, Windows 2000, or
Windows XP the information can be displayed in colorful graphics. Also, the software can be oper-
ated using either a mouse or a keyboard.
In addition, the data for the main functions (Diagnosis, Diagnosis record, Engine monitor, and Data
2
logger) can be saved on a disk or printed out.

Functions
1. Diagnosis: With the engine main switch ON, each sensor’s status and each ECM diagnosis
code or item is displayed. This enables you to find malfunctioning parts and controls quickly.
3
2. Diagnosis record: Sensors that had been activated and ECM diagnostic codes that have been
recorded are displayed. This allows you to check the outboard motor’s record of malfunctions.

3. Engine monitor: Each sensor status and the ECM data are displayed while the engine is run-
4
ning. This enables you to find malfunctioning parts quickly.

4. Stationary test: With the engine off, the ignition, fuel injection, electric fuel pump, and ISC
valve are checked. These tests can be performed quickly.
5
5. Active test: With the engine running the ISC valve is checked.

6. Data logger: Displays 13 minutes of recorded data for two or more of the items stored in the
ECM. In addition, the operating time as compared to the engine speed and the total operating
time are displayed. This allows you to check the operating status of the engine.
6
7. Some files: Lets you select and run other applications while continuing to run the diagnostic
program.

Contents
7
1. Software (1)

2. Adapter (1)

3. Communication cable (1)


YAMAHA
DIAGNOSTIC
SYSTEM

INSTRUCTION MANUAL
YAMAHA
DIAGNOSTIC
SYSTEM
INSTALLATION MANUAL
8
4. Instruction Manual (1)

5. Installation Manual (1)


1 2 3 4 5
9
63P3F11 9-2
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting
Hardware requirements
Make sure that your computer meets the following requirements before using this software.

Computer: IBM-compatible computer


Operating system: Microsoft (Windows 95,) Windows 98, Windows Me, Windows 2000, or
Windows XP (English version)
CPU:
Windows 95/98: i486X, 100 MHz or higher (Pentium 100 MHz or higher recommended)
Windows Me/2000: Pentium, 166 MHz or higher (Pentium 233 MHz or higher recommended)
Windows XP: Pentium, 300 MHz or higher (Pentium 500 MHz or higher recommended)
Memory:
Windows 95/98: 16 MB or more (32 MB or more recommended)
Windows Me: 32 MB or more (64 MB or more recommended)
Windows 2000: 64 MB or more (128 MB or more recommended)
Windows XP: 128 MB or more (256 MB or more recommended)
Hard disk free space: 20 MB or more (40 MB or more recommended)
Drive: CD-ROM drive
Display: VGA (640 × 480 pixels), (SVGA [800 × 600 pixels] or more recommended)
256 or more colors
Mouse: Compatible with the operating systems mentioned above
Communication port: RS232C (Dsub-9 pin) port, USB port
Printer: Compatible with the operating systems mentioned above

NOTE:
• The amount of memory and the amount of free space on the hard disk differs depending on the
computer.
• Using this software while there is not enough free space on the hard disk could cause errors and
result in insufficient memory.
• This software will not run properly on some computers.
• When starting up this program, do not start other software applications.
• Do not use the screen saver function or the energy saving feature when using this program.
• If the ECM is changed, restart the program.
• Window XP is a multiuser operating system, therefore, be sure to end this program if the login
user is changed.
• The USB adapter cannot be used with Windows 95.

For operating instructions of the Yamaha Diagnostic System, refer to the “Yamaha Diagnostic Sys-
tem Instruction Manual.”

9-3 63P3F11
Yamaha Diagnostic System
Connecting the communication cable to the outboard motor
Models: F(L)150A
Bow view

1
2
3
3-pin communication coupler

4
5
S63P9030
6
7
8
9
63P3F11 9-4
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting

NOTE:
• Before troubleshooting the outboard motor, check the compression pressure, the mounting and
rigging of the outboard motor, and the operation of the engine start switch. Also, make sure that
specified fuel has been used and that the battery is fully charged.
• To diagnose a mechanical malfunction, use the troubleshooting charts for each trouble located in
this chapter. Also, when checking and maintaining the outboard motor, see Chapters 3–8 for safe
maintenance procedures.
• To diagnose a sensor or switch malfunction, use the diagnostic flash indicator to determine the
cause.

Power unit 9

Symptom 1: Engine does not start, or starting the engine is difficult.

Starting system

Check the starter motor opera-


tion.

Good operating Yes Check the ignition system and


condition? fuel system.
No

Check the battery lead connec-


tions and the starter motor posi-
tive terminal for damage and
check that the ground lead bolt
is not loose or that it has not
come off. Check for blown
fuses.

No Repair or replace the defective


Good condition?
parts.
Yes

Check the starter relay for conti-


nuity.

Continued on next page.

9-5 63P3F11
Power unit

Is there continuity?

Yes
No
Replace the starter relay.
1
Check the wiring harness for
continuity.
2
No Repair or replace the wiring har-
Is there continuity?
ness.
Yes

Disassemble and check the


3
starter motor.

4
5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11 9-6
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting
Ignition system

Check the condition of the spark


plugs.

No Clean, adjust, or replace the


Good condition?
spark plugs.
Yes

Check the ignition spark using


the spark gap tester.

WARNING
• Do not touch any of the connections of the spark gap tester leads.
• Do not let sparks leak out of the removed spark plug caps.
• Keep flammable gas and liquids away, since this test can produce
sparks.

Good spark? Yes Check the pulser coil output


peak voltage or resistance.
No

No Replace the stator


Good condition?
assembly.
Yes

Check the ignition coil resis- Check the starting system or


tance. the fuel system.

No Repair or replace the defective


Good condition?
parts.
Yes
Check the spark plug wire resis-
tance and the spark plug caps
for salt buildup.

Continued on next page.

9-7 63P3F11
Power unit

Good condition?

Yes
No Repair or replace the spark plug
wires. 1
Check the main relay for conti-
nuity.
2
No
Is there continuity? Replace the main relay.

Yes

Check the ECM output peak


3
voltage.

4
Fuel system

Check the electric fuel pump


operation.
5
Can the opera-
tion sound be
heard?
No
Check the fuse holder, fuse,
and wiring harness for continu-
ity.
6
Yes

Is there continuity?

Yes
No Repair or replace
the defective parts. 7
Check the fuel filters for clogs
and the hoses for leaks.
Replace the electrical fuel
pump.
8
Continued on next page.
9
63P3F11 9-8
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting

Yes Repair or replace the defective


Clogs or leaks?
parts.
No

Check the fuel pump


diaphragm.

Yes
Cracks or damage? Replace the diaphragm.

No

Check the vapor separator


needle valve.

Is the needle valve Yes


Replace the needle valve.
bent or worn?
No
Check the injector resistance
and check the injectors for
clogs.

No
Good condition? Replace the injectors.

Yes

Check the starting system or


the ignition system.

9-9 63P3F11
Power unit
Symptom 2: Engine speed at wide open throttle is low, engine speed decreases, or engine
stalls (poor acceleration or poor deceleration).

Check the battery lead connec-


tions and check that the ground
lead bolt is not loose or that it
has not come off.
1
Good condition?

Yes
No Repair or replace the defective
parts. 2
Check the throttle position sen-
sor and check that the connec-
tor is securely connected. 3
4
No Repair or replace the defective
Good condition?
part.
Yes
Check the throttle valves for

5
bends or for stuck throttle valve
shafts.

No
Good condition? Replace the throttle body.

Yes

Check the ignition system or the


6
fuel system.

7
8
9
63P3F11 9-10
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting
Ignition system

Check the condition of the spark


plugs.

No Clean, adjust, or replace the


Good condition?
spark plugs.
Yes

Check the ignition spark using


the spark gap tester.

WARNING
• Do not touch any of the connections of the spark gap tester leads.
• Do not let sparks leak out of the removed spark plug caps.
• Keep flammable gas and liquids away, since this test can produce
sparks.

Yes Check the pulser coil output


Good spark?
peak voltage or resistance.
No

No Replace the stator


Good condition?
assembly.
Yes

Check the ignition coil resis-


Check the fuel system.
tance.

No Repair or replace the defective


Good condition?
parts.
Yes
Check the spark plug wire resis-
tance and check the spark plug
caps for salt buildup.

Continued on next page.

9-11 63P3F11
Power unit

Good condition?

Yes
No Repair or replace the spark plug
wires.
1
Check the ECM output peak
voltage.
2
Fuel system 3
Check the electric fuel pump
operation.

Can the opera- Check the fuse holder, fuse,


4
No
tion sound be and wiring harness for continu-
heard?
Yes
ity.

No Repair or replace
5
Is there continuity?
the defective parts.

Check the fuel filters for clogs


Yes

Replace the electric fuel pump.


6
and the hoses for leaks.

Good condition?
No Repair or replace the defective
parts.
7
Yes

Check the fuel pump dia-


phragm. 8
Continued on next page. 9
63P3F11 9-12
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting

Yes
Cracks or damage? Replace the diaphragm.

No

Check the vapor separator nee-


dle valve.

Is the needle valve Yes


Replace the needle valve.
bent or worn?
No

Check the vapor separator


pressure regulator.

No
Good condition? Replace the pressure regulator.

Yes
Check the injector resistance
and check the injectors for
clogs.

No
Good condition? Replace the injectors.

Yes

Check the starting system or


the ignition system.

9-13 63P3F11
Power unit
Lubrication system

1
Check the engine oil level.

No Add engine oil to the correct


At specified level?
level.
Yes

Check the oil pressure.


2
Within specification?
No Check the oil pump for debris or
oil leaks.
3
Yes

Debris or leaks?

Yes
No Check the oil
passage. 4
Check the oil pressure sensor.
Clean or replace the defective
parts.
5
No
Good condition?

6
Replace the oil pressure sensor.

Yes

Check the ignition system or the


fuel system.

7
8
9
63P3F11 9-14
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting
Symptom 3: Engine speed not stable at low speeds.

Check the throttle position sen-


sor and check that the connec-
tor is securely connected.

No Repair or replace the defective


Good condition?
part.
Yes

Check the neutral switch for


continuity.

No Repair or replace the defective


Is there continuity?
parts.
Yes

Check the throttle valve opening


of each cylinder.

Are the throttle


valve openings
incorrect or are Yes
Replace the throttle body.
the throttle valve
links worn?
No

Check the ignition system or the


fuel system.

9-15 63P3F11
Power unit
Ignition system

Check the condition of the spark


plugs.

No Clean, adjust, or replace the


1
Good condition?
spark plugs.
Yes

Check the ignition spark using


the spark gap tester.
2
WARNING
3
• Do not touch any of the connections of the spark gap tester leads.
• Do not let sparks leak out of the removed spark plug caps.
• Keep flammable gas and liquids away, since this test can produce
sparks. 4
Good spark?

No
Yes
Check the fuel system.
5
Check the ignition coil resis-
tance.

No Repair or replace the defective


6
Good condition?
parts.
Yes
Check the spark plug wire resis-
tance and check the spark plug
7
caps for salt buildup.

Good condition?
No Repair or replace the spark plug
wires.
8
9
Yes

Check the ECM output peak


voltage.

63P3F11 9-16
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting
Fuel system

Check the fuel pump dia-


phragm.

Yes
Cracks or damage? Replace the diaphragm.

No

Check the vapor separator nee-


dle valve.

Is the needle valve Yes


Replace the needle valve.
bent or worn?
No
Check the injector resistance
and check the injectors for
clogs.

No
Good condition? Replace the injectors.

Yes

Check the ignition system.

9-17 63P3F11
Power unit
Symptom 4: Hunting occurs.

Check the throttle valve opening


of each cylinder.

Are the throttle


1
valves open Yes Synchronize the throttle valves
or replace the defective parts.
excessively?
No

Adjust the throttle cable.


2
3
4
Symptom 5: Engine speed rises even when the throttle position is fixed.

Check the throttle cable


operation.
5
Good condition?

Yes
No
Adjust the throttle cable.
6
Synchronize the throttle valves.

7
8
9
63P3F11 9-18
TRBL
SHTG Troubleshooting
Self-diagnosis 9

Diagnosing the electronic control


system
1. Connect the special service tool to the
outboard motor as shown.

• Trouble code indication


Example: The illustration indicates
L/W code number 23.
a: Light on, 0.33 second
b: Light off, 4.95 seconds
c: Light off, 0.33 second
d: Light off, 1.65 seconds

S63P9010

NOTE:
When performing this diagnosis, all of the
electrical wires must be properly connected.

Diagnostic flash indicator B: 4. If a flash pattern listed in the diagnostic


90890-06865 code chart is displayed, check the mal-
functioning part according to the flash
2. Start the engine and let it idle. pattern.

3. Check the flash pattern of the diagnostic NOTE:


flash indicator to determine if there are When more than one problem is detected,
any malfunctions. the light of the diagnostic flash indicator
flashes in the pattern of the lowest numbered
• Normal condition problem. After that problem is corrected, the
(no defective part or irregular process- light flashes in the pattern of the next lowest
ing is found) numbered problem. This continues until all of
the problems are detected and corrected.
• Single flash is given every 4.95 sec-
onds.
a: Light on, 0.33 second
b: Light off, 4.95 seconds

9-19 63P3F11
Self-diagnosis

Code Symptom
1 Normal

1
13 Incorrect pulser coil signal
Incorrect engine temperature
15
sensor signal
Incorrect throttle position sensor
18
signal
19

23
Incorrect battery voltage
Incorrect intake air temperature
sensor signal
2
28 Incorrect neutral switch signal

29

37
Incorrect intake air pressure
sensor signal
Incorrect idle speed control
3
signal

39

44
Incorrect oil pressure sensor
signal
Incorrect engine stop lanyard
switch signal
4
45 Incorrect shift cut switch signal
46 Incorrect thermoswitch signal
5
6
7
8
9
63P3F11 9-20
Index

Numerics C.
64E type power trim and tilt unit................1-11 Changing the engine oil by draining it ........ 3-5
Changing the engine oil using an
A. oil changer ................................................ 3-4
Changing the gear oil ............................... 3-14
Adjusting the throttle link and
Charging system....................................... 8-24
throttle cable .............................................3-8
Checking the anodes................................ 3-15
Adjusting the throttle link and throttle cable
Checking the armature ............................. 8-22
operation (using a thickness gauge) .......3-10
Checking the balancer assembly.............. 5-41
Adjusting the throttle position sensor ........4-17
Checking the battery........................1-22, 3-16
Adjusting the throttle position sensor
(when disassembling or replacing the Checking the bearings.....................6-18, 6-47
Checking the brushes............................... 8-23
throttle body) ...........................................4-18
Adjusting the trim sensor cam...................7-18 Checking the camshaft ............................. 5-33
Aft view .......................................................8-5 Checking the check valve......................... 4-14
Checking the compression pressure ........ 5-11
After test run .............................................1-25
Applicable models.......................................1-5 Checking the connecting rod big end
Assembling a fuel pump..............................4-8 side clearance ........................................ 5-43
Checking the cooling water passage.......... 3-8
Assembling the drive shaft
housing ......................................... 6-19, 6-48 Checking the cooling water pilot hole ....... 1-25
Checking the crankpin oil clearance......... 5-45
Assembling the forward gear ....................6-19
Checking the crankshaft ........................... 5-44
Assembling the gear pump housing..........7-35
Checking the crankshaft main journal oil
Assembling the lower case ............. 6-19, 6-47
clearance ................................................ 5-47
Assembling the oil pan..............................7-12
Checking the cylinder bore ....................... 5-42
Assembling the oil pump...........................5-49
Checking the cylinder head ...................... 5-34
Assembling the pistons and
Checking the diaphragm and valves .......... 4-8
cylinder block ..........................................5-50
Checking the drive shaft ..................6-18, 6-47
Assembling the power trim and tilt motor ...7-33
Checking the ECM.................................... 8-12
Assembling the power trim and tilt unit .....7-40
Assembling the propeller shaft Checking the electric fuel pump ............... 8-17
assembly.................................................6-14 Checking the electrical components........... 8-2
Checking the engine idle speed ................. 3-8
Assembling the propeller shaft
housing ......................................... 6-14, 6-41 Checking the engine oil .............................. 3-4
Checking the engine oil level.................... 1-22
Assembling the reverse gear ....................6-48
Checking the engine start switch and
Assembling the tilt piston and
engine stop lanyard switch ..................... 1-24
trim pistons..............................................7-39
Checking the engine temperature
sensor..................................................... 8-13
B. Checking the fuel filter ................................ 3-3
Backlash (counter rotation model) ............6-60 Checking the fuel joint and fuel hoses
Backlash (regular rotation model) .............6-29 (fuel joint-to-fuel injector) .......................... 3-3
Balancer......................................................1-7 Checking the fuel pumps ............................ 4-7
Bleeding the power trim and tilt unit..........7-43 Checking the fuel system ......................... 1-22
Bleeding the power trim and tilt unit Checking the fuse..................................... 7-47
(built-in) ...................................................7-45 Checking the fuses ................................... 8-19
Bottom cowling............................................7-2 Checking the gear oil level ..............1-22, 3-13
Break-in.....................................................1-25 Checking the gear pump .......................... 7-35
Checking the gear shift and
throttle operation..................................... 1-24
Checking the gear shift operation............. 3-11
Checking the hydraulic pressure .............. 7-28
Checking the ignition coils ........................ 8-11
Checking the ignition spark gap ............... 8-11
Checking the ignition timing...................... 3-12

i-1 63P3F11
Index
Checking the injectors...............................8-17 Checking the top cowling............................ 3-3
Checking the intake air temperature Checking the trim sensor.......................... 7-48
sensor .....................................................8-13 Checking the valve clearance............3-6, 5-12
Checking the lower case................. 6-18, 6-47 Checking the valve guides........................ 5-29
Checking the lower unit for air leakage.....3-15
Checking the magnet switch .....................8-23
Checking the main relay ...........................8-17
Checking the neutral switch ......................8-14
Checking the valve seat ........................... 5-31
Checking the valve springs....................... 5-28
Checking the valves ................................. 5-29
Checking the vapor separator .................. 4-15
1
Checking the oil pressure .........................5-11 Checking the water pump and
Checking the oil pressure sensor..............5-12
Checking the oil pump ..............................5-49
Checking the oil strainer ...........................7-12
Checking the outboard motor mounting
shift rod............................................6-9, 6-37
Clamp brackets......................................... 7-16
Connecting rod ........................................... 1-8
Control system............................................ 3-8
2
height ......................................................1-23 Cooling system ......................................... 1-12
Checking the pinion and forward gear ......6-18
Checking the pinion and reverse gear ......6-47
Checking the piston clearance..................5-42
Checking the piston diameter ...................5-41
Crankshaft and cylinder.............................. 1-6
Cylinder block ........................................... 5-38
Cylinder head ........................................... 5-23
Cylinder head cover.................................... 1-8
3
Checking the piston ring grooves..............5-43
D.
4
Checking the piston ring side clearance ...5-43
Checking the piston rings..........................5-42
Diagnosing the electronic control
Checking the power trim and tilt
system .................................................... 9-19
fluid level .................................................3-13
Dimensions................................................. 2-9
Checking the power trim and tilt motor .....7-31
Disassembling a fuel pump ........................ 4-7
Checking the power trim and tilt

5
Disassembling the cylinder block ............. 5-41
operation .................................................3-13
Disassembling the drive shaft
Checking the power trim and tilt relay.......7-47
housing ..........................................6-17, 6-46
Checking the power trim and tilt switch.....7-47
Disassembling the forward gear ......6-17, 6-40
Checking the power trim and tilt system ...1-24
Disassembling the gear pump housing .... 7-34
Checking the pressure control valve.........5-37
Disassembling the lower case .........6-17, 6-46
Checking the pressure regulator...............4-13
Checking the propeller ..............................3-15
Checking the propeller shaft ........... 6-13, 6-41
Checking the propeller shaft
Disassembling the oil pan......................... 7-12
Disassembling the oil pump...................... 5-49
Disassembling the power trim and tilt
motor ...................................................... 7-30
6
housing ......................................... 6-13, 6-41 Disassembling the propeller shaft
Checking the pulser coil............................8-12
Checking the Rectifier Regulator ..............8-25
Checking the remote control cables..........1-23
Checking the shift cut switch.....................8-14
assembly .......................................6-12, 6-40
Disassembling the propeller shaft
housing ..........................................6-12, 6-41
Disassembling the reverse gear ............... 6-46
7
Checking the spark plug wires ..................8-11
Disassembling the tilt cylinder and

8
Checking the spark plugs............................3-6
trim cylinder ............................................ 7-37
Checking the starter motor operation........8-23
Disassembly and assembly ........................ 1-4
Checking the starter motor pinion .............8-22
Draining the engine oil.............................. 7-12
Checking the starter relay .........................8-19
Drive shaft and lower case
Checking the stator coil.............................8-25
(counter rotation model) ......................... 6-44
Checking the steering system...................1-24
Checking the thermostat .............................3-7
Checking the thermoswitch.......................8-14
Checking the throttle position sensor........8-13
Checking the tilt cylinder and
Drive shaft and lower case
(regular rotation model) .......................... 6-16
9
trim cylinder.............................................7-38
Checking the timing belt..............................3-6
Checking the timing belt and sprockets ....5-21

63P3F11 i-2
Index

E. L.
ECM ..........................................................1-17 Lower unit ..........................................2-6, 3-13
Electrical .....................................................2-7 Lower unit (counter rotation model).......... 6-32
Electrical components.................................8-3 Lower unit (regular rotation model)............. 6-4
Electronic control system ..........................1-17 Lubricating the outboard motor................. 3-16
Lubrication system.................................... 1-13
F.
Fail-safe control ........................................1-18 M.
Features and benefits .................................1-6 Maintenance interval chart ......................... 3-2
Fire prevention ............................................1-3 Maintenance specification .......................... 2-3
Fuel and blowby hoses ...............................4-2 Manual format............................................. 1-1
Fuel control system...................................8-15 Measuring the forward and
Fuel filter, fuel pump, and intake silencer ...4-3 reverse gear backlash ...................6-29, 6-60
Fuel pump control .....................................1-20 Measuring the fuel pressure ..................... 4-13
Fuel system....................................... 1-15, 3-3 Measuring the lower resistance.................. 8-2
Measuring the peak voltage ....................... 8-2
G.
General .....................................................3-15 O.
General specifications.................................2-1 Over-revolution control ............................. 1-20
General torques ........................................2-13
Good working practices ..............................1-4 P.
Parts, lubricants, and sealants ................... 1-3
H. Piston and piston ring ................................. 1-7
Hose routing................................................4-2 Port view..................................................... 8-3
How to use this manual...............................1-1 Power trim and tilt electrical system ......... 7-46
Power trim and tilt unit .....................3-13, 7-20
I. Power unit............................ 2-3, 3-4, 5-3, 9-5
Predelivery checks ................................... 1-22
Identification................................................1-5
Propeller selection .................................... 1-21
Ignition and ignition control system.............8-9
Propeller shaft housing
Installing the clamp brackets.....................7-18
(counter rotation model) ......................... 6-38
Installing the cylinder head .......................5-35
Propeller shaft housing
Installing the drive shaft .................. 6-20, 6-49
(regular rotation model) .......................... 6-10
Installing the lower unit ................... 6-23, 6-52
Propeller size............................................ 1-21
Installing the power trim and tilt unit..........7-44
Installing the power unit ............................5-55
Installing the pressure control valve..........5-37 R.
Installing the propeller shaft Rectifier Regulator.................................... 1-16
housing ......................................... 6-21, 6-49 Reducing the fuel pressure....................... 4-15
Installing the sprockets and timing belt .....5-21 Refacing the valve seat ............................ 5-31
Installing the steering arm.........................7-14 Removing the clamp brackets .................. 7-18
Installing the upper case ...........................7-15 Removing the cylinder head ..................... 5-28
Installing the valves...................................5-34 Removing the drive shaft.................6-17, 6-46
Installing the water pump and Removing the exhaust cover .................... 5-37
shift rod ......................................... 6-21, 6-50 Removing the lower unit ....................6-8, 6-36
Intake assembly and vapor separator.........4-9 Removing the oil filter ............................... 5-20
Intake system..............................................1-9 Removing the power trim and tilt unit ....... 7-27
Introduction .................................................9-2 Removing the power unit.......................... 5-18
Isolator ......................................................1-16 Removing the propeller shaft
housing assembly..........................6-12, 6-40
J. Removing the reservoir ............................ 7-33
Removing the starter motor pinion ........... 8-22
Junction box assembly................................8-4

i-3 63P3F11
Index
Removing the steering arm.......................7-14 Y.
Removing the timing belt and sprockets ...5-20
Yamaha Diagnostic System ....................... 9-2
Removing the water pump and
shift rod ........................................... 6-8, 6-36
Replacing the oil filter..................................3-5
Replacing the timing belt................... 3-6, 5-16
Replacing the valve guides .......................5-30
1
S.
Safety while working ...................................1-3
Selecting the connecting rod bearing........5-46
Selecting the crankshaft main bearing......5-48
Selecting the forward gear shims.... 6-27, 6-57
2
Selecting the pinion shims .............. 6-26, 6-55
Selecting the propeller shaft shims ...........6-58
Selecting the reverse gear shims.... 6-28, 6-56
Selection ...................................................1-21
Self-diagnosis ...........................................9-19
3
Self-protection.............................................1-3
Serial number..............................................1-5
Shift cut control .........................................1-20
Shimming ........................................ 6-26, 6-55
Shimming (counter rotation model)...........6-54
4
Shimming (regular rotation model)............6-25

5
Special service
tools ............ 3-1, 4-1, 5-1, 6-1, 7-1, 8-1, 9-1
Specified torques ......................................2-11
Starter motor .............................................8-20
Starting system .........................................8-18

6
Symbols ......................................................1-2
Synchronizing the throttle valves ..............4-16

T.
Technical tips ............................................1-17

7
Test run.....................................................1-25
Tightening torques ....................................2-11
Top cowling....................................... 1-10, 3-3
Top view......................................................8-6

U.
Upper case, steering arm,
swivel bracket and clamp brackets ...........7-6 8
V.

W.
Ventilation ...................................................1-3

Warning control.........................................1-19
9
Wiring harness ............................................8-7

63P3F11 i-4
Wiring diagram
F150AET, FL150AET
1 Spark plug Color code
2 Ignition coil B : Black
3 Thermoswitch Br : Brown
4 Oil pressure sensor G : Green
5 Diode Gy : Gray
6 Starter relay L : Blue
7 Starter motor Lg : Light green
8 Starting battery O : Orange
9 Accessory battery P : Pink
0 Fuse holder R : Red
A Fuse (30 A) Sb : Sky blue
B Fuse (20 A) W : White
C Fuse (50 A) Y : Yellow
D Intake air temperature sensor B/O : Black/orange
E Power trim and tilt relay B/W : Black/white
F Power trim and tilt motor B/Y : Black/yellow
G ECM Br/W : Brown/white
H Pulser coil G/B : Green/black
I Stator coil G/R : Green/red
J Engine temperature sensor G/Y : Green/yellow
K Rectifier Regulator L/G : Blue/green
L Power trim and tilt switch L/W : Blue/white
M Trim sensor L/Y : Blue/yellow
N Idle speed control P/B : Pink/black
O Throttle position sensor P/G : Pink/green
P Intake air pressure sensor P/W : Pink/white
Q Fuel injector Pu/B : Purple/black
R Electric fuel pump Pu/G : Purple/green
S Shift cut switch Pu/R : Purple/red
T Neutral switch Pu/Y : Purple/yellow
U Main relay R/Y : Red/yellow
W/B : White/black
È To personal computer for diagnosis W/R : White/red
É To remote control box/switch panel Y/G : Yellow/green
Ê To trim meter
Ë To warning indicator
Ì To diagnostic flash indicator
(special service tool)

(*1) Isolator cable (optional)


(*2) Negative cable (commercially available)
YAMAHA MOTOR CO., LTD.

Printed in the Netherlands


Jul. 2003 – 1.2 × 1 CR
(E)
F150AET, FL150AET B/Y B

1 2 3 4 7 8 9 10 J B/Y
B/Y
B
B/Y

G Y/G P W B/Y B L/Y O B/Y


B/Y
12 14 15 17 18 19 20 G B B
O W/R W/B L G/B G G/R W/R B B
G/R G/B R/Y L/G Pu/G Pu/Y Pu/B L Pu/R P/G P B
21 22 23 24 26 27 28 29 30 W/B W/B B
B B G/Y G L/Y R/Y R/Y R/Y R/Y R/Y O B
G/Y B/O P/B P/W W/B L/W Y P/W R/Y B
W/R
B
31 32 33 34 35 37 38 39 40 W/B W/R B
L/G B P/G P B/Y P Pu/Y Pu/B Pu/R B
B B
R/Y B
P B 42 43 44
B Pu/G B/W W/R
B
B/O B/W
R/Y R/Y B
R/Y R/Y P/W O B/W
B
B O B/O
P
H
P/W P/W
O B

R
B/O
R
B/W W/R
W/B
B
B H #2/3 #1/4
B/Y
P B G/R
G/B
B/W B/W G/Y
G
B
P
I B P

O G
4 P/G G
B/W R B/W R
3 Pu/R
L
G
O
O
Pu/B
2 2 Pu/Y
Pu/G O
L/Y
1 4 2 3 L/G
P/W O
B
P/B
W
P
B Y
B P
L/W G 2 R/Y B
P/G
1 1 1 1 Y/G
R/Y
B/Y
W/B B
3 G/B
R/Y G/R 1
R/Y
R/Y
R/Y
R/Y
R/Y 6G G/Y 4 R/Y
B
R/Y R/Y 5
R/Y 123456
R/Y
R
R/Y
Pu/R Q
L/W #1
Br
R N Pu/R
6 Sb
Lg
Sb
Lg Sb
L
R/Y

B B Lg
Br Lg L L
Sb
R/Y R/Y
R Sb Lg
G
R/Y L
G R/Y
R/Y L
Br Br/W

B
R/Y W/B
G
G
R/Y
Pu/B Q
P R G
L/W B Sb Lg 0 È R/Y G Y G
#2
L/W
E
W/B
B G W
B K Pu/B R/Y

1 A B
R
P
R R/Y
D B Lg
Y
É R
B
Pu/Y Q
C Sb
B W #3
B
A D Br
Sb R
Pu/Y
R/Y
Ì 5 0
B/Y
B Lg
Br B
R

9 B/Y
8 B R/Y
Pu/G Q
7
#4
R
6
5 U Pu/G
4 B RR B B
3 Lg Sb B B B
2
C Sb Lg
L/Y
B
L/Y
B S
B G I B
L/W
C B
P/B B
L/Y
B
F H P/W
B L/G
B
L/G
B T
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 RR Lg R Sb
Lg L/G
Y/G R R R R/Y R/Y R/Y R/Y R/Y R/Y Sb

11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
7 R/Y R/Y R/Y R/Y R R R R R
Sb
Lg Sb R Lg
UP
Sb L
B
E Sb Lg FREE
DOWN

R
Sb Sb
R R
R Lg Lg
Lg Sb L/W R
B B (*1) B
B (*2) B
B
M
9 P

F P/B
Ë P/W Gy
8 Lg
Sb
P
Ê
Gy

S63PWD02

You might also like